terraform/vendor/github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds/api.go

28404 lines
1012 KiB
Go

// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT.
package rds
import (
"fmt"
"time"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/query"
)
const opAddRoleToDBCluster = "AddRoleToDBCluster"
// AddRoleToDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddRoleToDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddRoleToDBCluster for more information on using the AddRoleToDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddRoleToDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBCluster
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddRoleToDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddRoleToDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &AddRoleToDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// AddRoleToDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Associates an Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from an Aurora DB
// cluster. For more information, see Authorizing Amazon Aurora to Access Other
// AWS Services On Your Behalf (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Authorizing.AWSServices.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddRoleToDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterRoleAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterRoleAlreadyExists"
// The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is already associated with
// the specified DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterRoleQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterRoleQuotaExceeded"
// You have exceeded the maximum number of IAM roles that can be associated
// with the specified DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBCluster
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBCluster(input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) (*AddRoleToDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext is the same as AddRoleToDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddRoleToDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddRoleToDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAddSourceIdentifierToSubscription = "AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription"
// AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for more information on using the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription
func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddSourceIdentifierToSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds a source identifier to an existing RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound"
// The requested source could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription
func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription(input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext is the same as AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAddTagsToResource = "AddTagsToResource"
// AddTagsToResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddTagsToResource operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddTagsToResource for more information on using the AddTagsToResource
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddTagsToResourceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddTagsToResourceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddTagsToResource
func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResourceRequest(input *AddTagsToResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddTagsToResourceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddTagsToResource,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddTagsToResourceInput{}
}
output = &AddTagsToResourceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// AddTagsToResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds metadata tags to an Amazon RDS resource. These tags can also be used
// with cost allocation reporting to track cost associated with Amazon RDS resources,
// or used in a Condition statement in an IAM policy for Amazon RDS.
//
// For an overview on tagging Amazon RDS resources, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddTagsToResource for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddTagsToResource
func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResource(input *AddTagsToResourceInput) (*AddTagsToResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddTagsToResourceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddTagsToResourceWithContext is the same as AddTagsToResource with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddTagsToResource for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddTagsToResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddTagsToResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddTagsToResourceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opApplyPendingMaintenanceAction = "ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction"
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for more information on using the ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction
func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opApplyPendingMaintenanceAction,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput{}
}
output = &ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Applies a pending maintenance action to a resource (for example, to a DB
// instance).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault"
// The specified resource ID was not found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction
func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction(input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext is the same as ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress = "AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress"
// AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput{}
}
output = &AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Enables ingress to a DBSecurityGroup using one of two forms of authorization.
// First, EC2 or VPC security groups can be added to the DBSecurityGroup if
// the application using the database is running on EC2 or VPC instances. Second,
// IP ranges are available if the application accessing your database is running
// on the Internet. Required parameters for this API are one of CIDR range,
// EC2SecurityGroupId for VPC, or (EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName
// or EC2SecurityGroupId for non-VPC).
//
// You can't authorize ingress from an EC2 security group in one AWS Region
// to an Amazon RDS DB instance in another. You can't authorize ingress from
// a VPC security group in one VPC to an Amazon RDS DB instance in another.
//
// For an overview of CIDR ranges, go to the Wikipedia Tutorial (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault "AuthorizationAlreadyExists"
// The specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is already authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded"
// DB security group authorization quota has been reached.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBClusterParameterGroup = "CopyDBClusterParameterGroup"
// CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CopyDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroup(input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CopyDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBClusterSnapshot = "CopyDBClusterSnapshot"
// CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CopyDBClusterSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBClusterSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies a snapshot of a DB cluster.
//
// To copy a DB cluster snapshot from a shared manual DB cluster snapshot, SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
// must be the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the shared DB cluster snapshot.
//
// You can copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region. In
// that case, the AWS Region where you call the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action
// is the destination AWS Region for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be
// copied to. To copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region,
// you must provide the following values:
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS Key Management System (AWS KMS) key identifier for
// the key to use to encrypt the copy of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination
// AWS Region.
//
// * PreSignedUrl - A URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request
// for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action to be called in the source AWS Region
// where the DB cluster snapshot is copied from. The pre-signed URL must
// be a valid request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot API action that can be
// executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted DB cluster
// snapshot to be copied.
//
// The pre-signed URL request must contain the following parameter values:
//
// KmsKeyId - The KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt the copy
// of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This is the
// same identifier for both the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action that is called
// in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the pre-signed
// URL.
//
// DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that the DB cluster snapshot
// will be created in.
//
// SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier for
// the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must be
// in the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For
// example, if you are copying an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from the
// us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier looks
// like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster-snapshot:aurora-cluster1-snapshot-20161115.
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
//
// * TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The identifier for the new copy
// of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region.
//
// * SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier
// for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must
// be in the ARN format for the source AWS Region and is the same value as
// the SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier in the pre-signed URL.
//
// To cancel the copy operation once it is in progress, delete the target DB
// cluster snapshot identified by TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier while that
// DB cluster snapshot is in "copying" status.
//
// For more information on copying encrypted DB cluster snapshots from one AWS
// Region to another, see Copying a DB Cluster Snapshot in the Same Account,
// Either in the Same Region or Across Regions (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html#USER_CopyDBClusterSnapshot.CrossRegion)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshot(input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBParameterGroup = "CopyDBParameterGroup"
// CopyDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBParameterGroup for more information on using the CopyDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified DB parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroup(input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CopyDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBSnapshot = "CopyDBSnapshot"
// CopyDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBSnapshot for more information on using the CopyDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input *CopyDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified DB snapshot. The source DB snapshot must be in the "available"
// state.
//
// You can copy a snapshot from one AWS Region to another. In that case, the
// AWS Region where you call the CopyDBSnapshot action is the destination AWS
// Region for the DB snapshot copy.
//
// You can't copy an encrypted, shared DB snapshot from one AWS Region to another.
//
// For more information about copying snapshots, see Copying a DB Snapshot (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopyDBSnapshot.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshot(input *CopyDBSnapshotInput) (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyOptionGroup = "CopyOptionGroup"
// CopyOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyOptionGroup for more information on using the CopyOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroupRequest(input *CopyOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &CopyOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified option group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault"
// The option group you are trying to create already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault"
// The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroup(input *CopyOptionGroupInput) (*CopyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyOptionGroupWithContext is the same as CopyOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBCluster = "CreateDBCluster"
// CreateDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBCluster for more information on using the CreateDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBCluster
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterRequest(input *CreateDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// You can use the ReplicationSourceIdentifier parameter to create the DB cluster
// as a Read Replica of another DB cluster or Amazon RDS MySQL DB instance.
// For cross-region replication where the DB cluster identified by ReplicationSourceIdentifier
// is encrypted, you must also specify the PreSignedUrl parameter.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be
// able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBCluster
func (c *RDS) CreateDBCluster(input *CreateDBClusterInput) (*CreateDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterWithContext is the same as CreateDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBClusterParameterGroup = "CreateDBClusterParameterGroup"
// CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Parameters in a DB cluster parameter group apply to all of the instances
// in a DB cluster.
//
// A DB cluster parameter group is initially created with the default parameters
// for the database engine used by instances in the DB cluster. To provide custom
// values for any of the parameters, you must modify the group after creating
// it using ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup. Once you've created a DB cluster
// parameter group, you need to associate it with your DB cluster using ModifyDBCluster.
// When you associate a new DB cluster parameter group with a running DB cluster,
// you need to reboot the DB instances in the DB cluster without failover for
// the new DB cluster parameter group and associated settings to take effect.
//
// After you create a DB cluster parameter group, you should wait at least 5
// minutes before creating your first DB cluster that uses that DB cluster parameter
// group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the create action before the DB cluster parameter group is used as the default
// for a new DB cluster. This is especially important for parameters that are
// critical when creating the default database for a DB cluster, such as the
// character set for the default database defined by the character_set_database
// parameter. You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console
// (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/) or the DescribeDBClusterParameters
// command to verify that your DB cluster parameter group has been created or
// modified.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroup(input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBClusterSnapshot = "CreateDBClusterSnapshot"
// CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CreateDBClusterSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBClusterSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a snapshot of a DB cluster. For more information on Amazon Aurora,
// see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshot(input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBInstance = "CreateDBInstance"
// CreateDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBInstance for more information on using the CreateDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstance
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceRequest(input *CreateDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstance
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstance(input *CreateDBInstanceInput) (*CreateDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBInstanceWithContext is the same as CreateDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBInstanceReadReplica = "CreateDBInstanceReadReplica"
// CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for more information on using the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBInstanceReadReplica,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBInstanceReadReplica API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB instance that acts as a Read Replica for an existing source
// DB instance. You can create a Read Replica for a DB instance running MySQL,
// MariaDB, or PostgreSQL. For more information, see Working with PostgreSQL,
// MySQL, and MariaDB Read Replicas (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_ReadRepl.html).
//
// Amazon Aurora does not support this action. You must call the CreateDBInstance
// action to create a DB instance for an Aurora DB cluster.
//
// All Read Replica DB instances are created with backups disabled. All other
// DB instance attributes (including DB security groups and DB parameter groups)
// are inherited from the source DB instance, except as specified below.
//
// Your source DB instance must have backup retention enabled.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault "DBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault"
// Indicates that the DBSubnetGroup should not be specified while creating read
// replicas that lie in the same region as the source instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupFault"
// Indicates the DBSubnetGroup does not belong to the same VPC as that of an
// existing cross region read replica of the same source instance.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplica(input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext is the same as CreateDBInstanceReadReplica with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBParameterGroup = "CreateDBParameterGroup"
// CreateDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB parameter group.
//
// A DB parameter group is initially created with the default parameters for
// the database engine used by the DB instance. To provide custom values for
// any of the parameters, you must modify the group after creating it using
// ModifyDBParameterGroup. Once you've created a DB parameter group, you need
// to associate it with your DB instance using ModifyDBInstance. When you associate
// a new DB parameter group with a running DB instance, you need to reboot the
// DB instance without failover for the new DB parameter group and associated
// settings to take effect.
//
// After you create a DB parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes
// before creating your first DB instance that uses that DB parameter group
// as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the create action before the parameter group is used as the default for a
// new DB instance. This is especially important for parameters that are critical
// when creating the default database for a DB instance, such as the character
// set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter.
// You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/)
// or the DescribeDBParameters command to verify that your DB parameter group
// has been created or modified.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroup(input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBSecurityGroup = "CreateDBSecurityGroup"
// CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBSecurityGroup for more information on using the CreateDBSecurityGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBSecurityGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBSecurityGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB security group. DB security groups control access to a DB
// instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBSecurityGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB security group with the name specified in DBSecurityGroupName already
// exists.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault "QuotaExceeded.DBSecurityGroup"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB security
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault "DBSecurityGroupNotSupported"
// A DB security group is not allowed for this action.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroup(input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBSecurityGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBSnapshot = "CreateDBSnapshot"
// CreateDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBSnapshot for more information on using the CreateDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input *CreateDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a DBSnapshot. The source DBInstance must be in "available" state.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshot(input *CreateDBSnapshotInput) (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBSubnetGroup = "CreateDBSubnetGroup"
// CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the CreateDBSubnetGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBSubnetGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBSubnetGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB subnet group. DB subnet groups must contain at least one
// subnet in at least two AZs in the AWS Region.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBSubnetGroupAlreadyExists"
// DBSubnetGroupName is already used by an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetGroupQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB subnet groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets in a
// DB subnet groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroup(input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBSubnetGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateEventSubscription = "CreateEventSubscription"
// CreateEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateEventSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateEventSubscription for more information on using the CreateEventSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateEventSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateEventSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateEventSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &CreateEventSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates an RDS event notification subscription. This action requires a topic
// ARN (Amazon Resource Name) created by either the RDS console, the SNS console,
// or the SNS API. To obtain an ARN with SNS, you must create a topic in Amazon
// SNS and subscribe to the topic. The ARN is displayed in the SNS console.
//
// You can specify the type of source (SourceType) you want to be notified of,
// provide a list of RDS sources (SourceIds) that triggers the events, and provide
// a list of event categories (EventCategories) for events you want to be notified
// of. For example, you can specify SourceType = db-instance, SourceIds = mydbinstance1,
// mydbinstance2 and EventCategories = Availability, Backup.
//
// If you specify both the SourceType and SourceIds, such as SourceType = db-instance
// and SourceIdentifier = myDBInstance1, you are notified of all the db-instance
// events for the specified source. If you specify a SourceType but do not specify
// a SourceIdentifier, you receive notice of the events for that source type
// for all your RDS sources. If you do not specify either the SourceType nor
// the SourceIdentifier, you are notified of events generated from all RDS sources
// belonging to your customer account.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateEventSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded"
// You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault "SubscriptionAlreadyExist"
// The supplied subscription name already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic"
// SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization"
// You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound"
// The SNS topic ARN does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound"
// The supplied category does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound"
// The requested source could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscription(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as CreateEventSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateOptionGroup = "CreateOptionGroup"
// CreateOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateOptionGroup for more information on using the CreateOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroupRequest(input *CreateOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new option group. You can create up to 20 option groups.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault"
// The option group you are trying to create already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault"
// The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroup(input *CreateOptionGroupInput) (*CreateOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateOptionGroupWithContext is the same as CreateOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBCluster = "DeleteDBCluster"
// DeleteDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBCluster for more information on using the DeleteDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBCluster
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// The DeleteDBCluster action deletes a previously provisioned DB cluster. When
// you delete a DB cluster, all automated backups for that DB cluster are deleted
// and can't be recovered. Manual DB cluster snapshots of the specified DB cluster
// are not deleted.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBCluster
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBCluster(input *DeleteDBClusterInput) (*DeleteDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterWithContext is the same as DeleteDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBClusterParameterGroup = "DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup"
// DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a specified DB cluster parameter group. The DB cluster parameter
// group to be deleted can't be associated with any DB clusters.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup(input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBClusterSnapshot = "DeleteDBClusterSnapshot"
// DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBClusterSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB cluster snapshot. If the snapshot is being copied, the copy
// operation is terminated.
//
// The DB cluster snapshot must be in the available state to be deleted.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshot(input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBInstance = "DeleteDBInstance"
// DeleteDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBInstance for more information on using the DeleteDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstance
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input *DeleteDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// The DeleteDBInstance action deletes a previously provisioned DB instance.
// When you delete a DB instance, all automated backups for that instance are
// deleted and can't be recovered. Manual DB snapshots of the DB instance to
// be deleted by DeleteDBInstance are not deleted.
//
// If you request a final DB snapshot the status of the Amazon RDS DB instance
// is deleting until the DB snapshot is created. The API action DescribeDBInstance
// is used to monitor the status of this operation. The action can't be canceled
// or reverted once submitted.
//
// Note that when a DB instance is in a failure state and has a status of failed,
// incompatible-restore, or incompatible-network, you can only delete it when
// the SkipFinalSnapshot parameter is set to true.
//
// If the specified DB instance is part of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster, you
// can't delete the DB instance if both of the following conditions are true:
//
// * The DB cluster is a Read Replica of another Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// * The DB instance is the only instance in the DB cluster.
//
// To delete a DB instance in this case, first call the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
// API action to promote the DB cluster so it's no longer a Read Replica. After
// the promotion completes, then call the DeleteDBInstance API action to delete
// the final instance in the DB cluster.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstance
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstance(input *DeleteDBInstanceInput) (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBInstanceWithContext is the same as DeleteDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBParameterGroup = "DeleteDBParameterGroup"
// DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a specified DBParameterGroup. The DBParameterGroup to be deleted
// can't be associated with any DB instances.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroup(input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBSecurityGroup = "DeleteDBSecurityGroup"
// DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBSecurityGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBSecurityGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBSecurityGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB security group.
//
// The specified DB security group must not be associated with any DB instances.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroup(input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSecurityGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBSnapshot = "DeleteDBSnapshot"
// DeleteDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DBSnapshot. If the snapshot is being copied, the copy operation
// is terminated.
//
// The DBSnapshot must be in the available state to be deleted.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshot(input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBSubnetGroup = "DeleteDBSubnetGroup"
// DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBSubnetGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBSubnetGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB subnet group.
//
// The specified database subnet group must not be associated with any DB instances.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetStateFault"
// The DB subnet is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroup(input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSubnetGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteEventSubscription = "DeleteEventSubscription"
// DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteEventSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteEventSubscription for more information on using the DeleteEventSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteEventSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteEventSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes an RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteEventSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault "InvalidEventSubscriptionState"
// This error can occur if someone else is modifying a subscription. You should
// retry the action.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscription(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as DeleteEventSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteOptionGroup = "DeleteOptionGroup"
// DeleteOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteOptionGroup for more information on using the DeleteOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input *DeleteOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes an existing option group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault"
// The option group is not in the available state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroup(input *DeleteOptionGroupInput) (*DeleteOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteOptionGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeAccountAttributes = "DescribeAccountAttributes"
// DescribeAccountAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeAccountAttributes operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeAccountAttributes for more information on using the DescribeAccountAttributes
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeAccountAttributesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeAccountAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeAccountAttributes,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeAccountAttributesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeAccountAttributesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeAccountAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists all of the attributes for a customer account. The attributes include
// Amazon RDS quotas for the account, such as the number of DB instances allowed.
// The description for a quota includes the quota name, current usage toward
// that quota, and the quota's maximum value.
//
// This command does not take any parameters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeAccountAttributes for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeAccountAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributes(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeAccountAttributes with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeAccountAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeCertificates = "DescribeCertificates"
// DescribeCertificatesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeCertificates operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeCertificates for more information on using the DescribeCertificates
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeCertificatesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeCertificatesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeCertificates
func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificatesRequest(input *DescribeCertificatesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeCertificatesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeCertificates,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeCertificatesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeCertificatesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeCertificates API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists the set of CA certificates provided by Amazon RDS for this AWS account.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeCertificates for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault "CertificateNotFound"
// CertificateIdentifier does not refer to an existing certificate.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeCertificates
func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificates(input *DescribeCertificatesInput) (*DescribeCertificatesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeCertificatesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeCertificatesWithContext is the same as DescribeCertificates with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeCertificates for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificatesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeCertificatesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeCertificatesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeCertificatesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterParameterGroups = "DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups"
// DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterParameterGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBClusterParameterGroup descriptions. If a DBClusterParameterGroupName
// parameter is specified, the list will contain only the description of the
// specified DB cluster parameter group.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups(input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterParameters = "DescribeDBClusterParameters"
// DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the detailed parameter list for a particular DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterParameters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameters(input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes = "DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes"
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DB cluster snapshot attribute names and values for a manual
// DB cluster snapshot.
//
// When sharing snapshots with other AWS accounts, DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// returns the restore attribute and a list of IDs for the AWS accounts that
// are authorized to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. If all
// is included in the list of values for the restore attribute, then the manual
// DB cluster snapshot is public and can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts.
//
// To add or remove access for an AWS account to copy or restore a manual DB
// cluster snapshot, or to make the manual DB cluster snapshot public or private,
// use the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterSnapshots = "DescribeDBClusterSnapshots"
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterSnapshots,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshots API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about DB cluster snapshots. This API action supports
// pagination.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshots(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterSnapshots with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusters = "DescribeDBClusters"
// DescribeDBClustersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusters for more information on using the DescribeDBClusters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClustersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClustersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersRequest(input *DescribeDBClustersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClustersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClustersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClustersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about provisioned Aurora DB clusters. This API supports
// pagination.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusters(input *DescribeDBClustersInput) (*DescribeDBClustersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClustersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClustersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClustersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClustersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClustersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBEngineVersions = "DescribeDBEngineVersions"
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBEngineVersions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBEngineVersions for more information on using the DescribeDBEngineVersions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBEngineVersions
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBEngineVersions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of the available DB engines.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBEngineVersions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBEngineVersions
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersions(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBEngineVersions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBEngineVersions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBEngineVersions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBEngineVersions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBEngineVersions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBInstances = "DescribeDBInstances"
// DescribeDBInstancesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBInstances operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBInstances for more information on using the DescribeDBInstances
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBInstancesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBInstancesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBInstances,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBInstancesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBInstancesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBInstances API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about provisioned RDS instances. This API supports pagination.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBInstances for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstances(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBInstancesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBInstances with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBInstances for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBInstancesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBInstances operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBInstances method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBInstances operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBInstancesPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBInstancesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPages(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBInstancesPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBInstancesInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBLogFiles = "DescribeDBLogFiles"
// DescribeDBLogFilesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBLogFiles operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBLogFiles for more information on using the DescribeDBLogFiles
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBLogFilesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBLogFiles
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBLogFiles,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBLogFilesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBLogFilesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBLogFiles API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DB log files for the DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBLogFiles for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBLogFiles
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFiles(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBLogFiles with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBLogFiles for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBLogFilesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBLogFiles operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBLogFiles method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBLogFiles operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBLogFilesPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPages(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBLogFilesPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBLogFilesInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBParameterGroups = "DescribeDBParameterGroups"
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBParameterGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBParameterGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBParameterGroup descriptions. If a DBParameterGroupName
// is specified, the list will contain only the description of the specified
// DB parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBParameterGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroups(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBParameterGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBParameterGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBParameterGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBParameterGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBParameters = "DescribeDBParameters"
// DescribeDBParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBParameters for more information on using the DescribeDBParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersRequest(input *DescribeDBParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the detailed parameter list for a particular DB parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBParameters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameters(input *DescribeDBParametersInput) (*DescribeDBParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBParameters operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBParameters method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBParameters operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBParametersPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersPages(input *DescribeDBParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParametersOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBParametersPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBParametersInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBParametersRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBParametersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBSecurityGroups = "DescribeDBSecurityGroups"
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSecurityGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSecurityGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSecurityGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBSecurityGroup descriptions. If a DBSecurityGroupName
// is specified, the list will contain only the descriptions of the specified
// DB security group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSecurityGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSecurityGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroups(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSecurityGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSecurityGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBSecurityGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBSnapshotAttributes = "DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes"
// DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for more information on using the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSnapshotAttributes,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DB snapshot attribute names and values for a manual DB
// snapshot.
//
// When sharing snapshots with other AWS accounts, DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// returns the restore attribute and a list of IDs for the AWS accounts that
// are authorized to copy or restore the manual DB snapshot. If all is included
// in the list of values for the restore attribute, then the manual DB snapshot
// is public and can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts.
//
// To add or remove access for an AWS account to copy or restore a manual DB
// snapshot, or to make the manual DB snapshot public or private, use the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes(input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBSnapshots = "DescribeDBSnapshots"
// DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSnapshots operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeDBSnapshots
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSnapshots,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSnapshotsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSnapshots API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about DB snapshots. This API action supports pagination.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSnapshots for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshots(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSnapshots with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSnapshots operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshots method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSnapshots operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBSnapshotsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPages(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSnapshotsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBSubnetGroups = "DescribeDBSubnetGroups"
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSubnetGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSubnetGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSubnetGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBSubnetGroup descriptions. If a DBSubnetGroupName is specified,
// the list will contain only the descriptions of the specified DBSubnetGroup.
//
// For an overview of CIDR ranges, go to the Wikipedia Tutorial (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSubnetGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSubnetGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroups(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSubnetGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSubnetGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBSubnetGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters = "DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters"
// DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the default engine and system parameter information for the cluster
// database engine.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters(input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeEngineDefaultParameters = "DescribeEngineDefaultParameters"
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for more information on using the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEngineDefaultParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"EngineDefaults.Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the default engine and system parameter information for the specified
// database engine.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParameters(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeEngineDefaultParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeEventCategories = "DescribeEventCategories"
// DescribeEventCategoriesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEventCategories operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEventCategories for more information on using the DescribeEventCategories
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventCategoriesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventCategories
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEventCategories,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEventCategoriesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEventCategoriesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEventCategories API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Displays a list of categories for all event source types, or, if specified,
// for a specified source type. You can see a list of the event categories and
// source types in the Events (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEventCategories for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventCategories
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategories(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext is the same as DescribeEventCategories with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEventCategories for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeEventSubscriptions = "DescribeEventSubscriptions"
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEventSubscriptions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEventSubscriptions for more information on using the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventSubscriptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEventSubscriptions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists all the subscription descriptions for a customer account. The description
// for a subscription includes SubscriptionName, SNSTopicARN, CustomerID, SourceType,
// SourceID, CreationTime, and Status.
//
// If you specify a SubscriptionName, lists the description for that subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEventSubscriptions for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventSubscriptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptions(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeEventSubscriptions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEventSubscriptions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeEventSubscriptions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeEvents = "DescribeEvents"
// DescribeEventsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEvents operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEvents for more information on using the DescribeEvents
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEventsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEvents
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsRequest(input *DescribeEventsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEvents,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEventsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEventsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEvents API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns events related to DB instances, DB security groups, DB snapshots,
// and DB parameter groups for the past 14 days. Events specific to a particular
// DB instance, DB security group, database snapshot, or DB parameter group
// can be obtained by providing the name as a parameter. By default, the past
// hour of events are returned.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEvents for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEvents
func (c *RDS) DescribeEvents(input *DescribeEventsInput) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventsWithContext is the same as DescribeEvents with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEvents for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEvents operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeEvents method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEvents operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeEventsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeEventsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsPages(input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeEventsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeEventsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeEventsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEventsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeOptionGroupOptions = "DescribeOptionGroupOptions"
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroupOptions for more information on using the DescribeOptionGroupOptions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroupOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeOptionGroupOptions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Describes all available options.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeOptionGroupOptions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroupOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptions(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOptionGroupOptions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroupOptions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroupOptions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeOptionGroups = "DescribeOptionGroups"
// DescribeOptionGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeOptionGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroups for more information on using the DescribeOptionGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOptionGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeOptionGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeOptionGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeOptionGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeOptionGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Describes the available option groups.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeOptionGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroups(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeOptionGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOptionGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOptionGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeOptionGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPages(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOptionGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeOptionGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions = "DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions"
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for more information on using the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of orderable DB instance options for the specified engine.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribePendingMaintenanceActions = "DescribePendingMaintenanceActions"
// DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for more information on using the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribePendingMaintenanceActions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribePendingMaintenanceActions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of resources (for example, DB instances) that have at least
// one pending maintenance action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault"
// The specified resource ID was not found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActions(input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext is the same as DescribePendingMaintenanceActions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeReservedDBInstances = "DescribeReservedDBInstances"
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeReservedDBInstances operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstances for more information on using the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeReservedDBInstances,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstances API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about reserved DB instances for this account, or about
// a specified reserved DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeReservedDBInstances for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstanceNotFound"
// The specified reserved DB Instance not found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstances(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedDBInstances with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstances for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstances operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstances method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstances operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings = "DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings"
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for more information on using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists available reserved DB instance offerings.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound"
// Specified offering does not exist.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeSourceRegions = "DescribeSourceRegions"
// DescribeSourceRegionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeSourceRegions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeSourceRegions for more information on using the DescribeSourceRegions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeSourceRegionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeSourceRegions
func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeSourceRegions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeSourceRegionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeSourceRegionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeSourceRegions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of the source AWS Regions where the current AWS Region can
// create a Read Replica or copy a DB snapshot from. This API action supports
// pagination.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeSourceRegions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeSourceRegions
func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegions(input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext is the same as DescribeSourceRegions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeSourceRegions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeValidDBInstanceModifications = "DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications"
// DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for more information on using the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeValidDBInstanceModifications,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// You can call DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications to learn what modifications
// you can make to your DB instance. You can use this information when you call
// ModifyDBInstance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications(input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext is the same as DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDownloadDBLogFilePortion = "DownloadDBLogFilePortion"
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DownloadDBLogFilePortion for more information on using the DownloadDBLogFilePortion
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DownloadDBLogFilePortion
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDownloadDBLogFilePortion,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "NumberOfLines",
TruncationToken: "AdditionalDataPending",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput{}
}
output = &DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortion API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Downloads all or a portion of the specified log file, up to 1 MB in size.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DownloadDBLogFilePortion for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault "DBLogFileNotFoundFault"
// LogFileName does not refer to an existing DB log file.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DownloadDBLogFilePortion
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortion(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext is the same as DownloadDBLogFilePortion with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DownloadDBLogFilePortion for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages iterates over the pages of a DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DownloadDBLogFilePortion method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages(params,
// func(page *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, fn func(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext same as DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, fn func(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opFailoverDBCluster = "FailoverDBCluster"
// FailoverDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the FailoverDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See FailoverDBCluster for more information on using the FailoverDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the FailoverDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.FailoverDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/FailoverDBCluster
func (c *RDS) FailoverDBClusterRequest(input *FailoverDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *FailoverDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opFailoverDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &FailoverDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &FailoverDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// FailoverDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Forces a failover for a DB cluster.
//
// A failover for a DB cluster promotes one of the Aurora Replicas (read-only
// instances) in the DB cluster to be the primary instance (the cluster writer).
//
// Amazon Aurora will automatically fail over to an Aurora Replica, if one exists,
// when the primary instance fails. You can force a failover when you want to
// simulate a failure of a primary instance for testing. Because each instance
// in a DB cluster has its own endpoint address, you will need to clean up and
// re-establish any existing connections that use those endpoint addresses when
// the failover is complete.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation FailoverDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/FailoverDBCluster
func (c *RDS) FailoverDBCluster(input *FailoverDBClusterInput) (*FailoverDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.FailoverDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// FailoverDBClusterWithContext is the same as FailoverDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See FailoverDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) FailoverDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *FailoverDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*FailoverDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.FailoverDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opListTagsForResource = "ListTagsForResource"
// ListTagsForResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ListTagsForResource operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ListTagsForResource for more information on using the ListTagsForResource
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ListTagsForResourceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ListTagsForResourceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ListTagsForResource
func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResourceRequest(input *ListTagsForResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListTagsForResourceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opListTagsForResource,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ListTagsForResourceInput{}
}
output = &ListTagsForResourceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ListTagsForResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists all tags on an Amazon RDS resource.
//
// For an overview on tagging an Amazon RDS resource, see Tagging Amazon RDS
// Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ListTagsForResource for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ListTagsForResource
func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResource(input *ListTagsForResourceInput) (*ListTagsForResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ListTagsForResourceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ListTagsForResourceWithContext is the same as ListTagsForResource with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ListTagsForResource for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListTagsForResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListTagsForResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ListTagsForResourceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBCluster = "ModifyDBCluster"
// ModifyDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBCluster for more information on using the ModifyDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBCluster
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modify a setting for an Amazon Aurora DB cluster. You can change one or more
// database configuration parameters by specifying these parameters and the
// new values in the request. For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora
// on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBCluster
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBCluster(input *ModifyDBClusterInput) (*ModifyDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterWithContext is the same as ModifyDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBClusterParameterGroup = "ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup"
// ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB cluster parameter group. To modify more than
// one parameter, submit a list of the following: ParameterName, ParameterValue,
// and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified in a single request.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Changes to dynamic parameters are applied immediately. Changes to static
// parameters require a reboot without failover to the DB cluster associated
// with the parameter group before the change can take effect.
//
// After you create a DB cluster parameter group, you should wait at least 5
// minutes before creating your first DB cluster that uses that DB cluster parameter
// group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the create action before the parameter group is used as the default for a
// new DB cluster. This is especially important for parameters that are critical
// when creating the default database for a DB cluster, such as the character
// set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter.
// You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/)
// or the DescribeDBClusterParameters command to verify that your DB cluster
// parameter group has been created or modified.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup(input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute = "ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute"
// ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds an attribute and values to, or removes an attribute and values from,
// a manual DB cluster snapshot.
//
// To share a manual DB cluster snapshot with other AWS accounts, specify restore
// as the AttributeName and use the ValuesToAdd parameter to add a list of IDs
// of the AWS accounts that are authorized to restore the manual DB cluster
// snapshot. Use the value all to make the manual DB cluster snapshot public,
// which means that it can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts. Do not
// add the all value for any manual DB cluster snapshots that contain private
// information that you don't want available to all AWS accounts. If a manual
// DB cluster snapshot is encrypted, it can be shared, but only by specifying
// a list of authorized AWS account IDs for the ValuesToAdd parameter. You can't
// use all as a value for that parameter in this case.
//
// To view which AWS accounts have access to copy or restore a manual DB cluster
// snapshot, or whether a manual DB cluster snapshot public or private, use
// the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual
// DB snapshot with.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute(input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBInstance = "ModifyDBInstance"
// ModifyDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBInstance for more information on using the ModifyDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBInstance
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input *ModifyDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies settings for a DB instance. You can change one or more database
// configuration parameters by specifying these parameters and the new values
// in the request. To learn what modifications you can make to your DB instance,
// call DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications before you call ModifyDBInstance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault "DBUpgradeDependencyFailure"
// The DB upgrade failed because a resource the DB depends on could not be modified.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault "CertificateNotFound"
// CertificateIdentifier does not refer to an existing certificate.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBInstance
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstance(input *ModifyDBInstanceInput) (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBInstanceWithContext is the same as ModifyDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBParameterGroup = "ModifyDBParameterGroup"
// ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB parameter group. To modify more than one
// parameter, submit a list of the following: ParameterName, ParameterValue,
// and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified in a single request.
//
// Changes to dynamic parameters are applied immediately. Changes to static
// parameters require a reboot without failover to the DB instance associated
// with the parameter group before the change can take effect.
//
// After you modify a DB parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes
// before creating your first DB instance that uses that DB parameter group
// as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the modify action before the parameter group is used as the default for a
// new DB instance. This is especially important for parameters that are critical
// when creating the default database for a DB instance, such as the character
// set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter.
// You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/)
// or the DescribeDBParameters command to verify that your DB parameter group
// has been created or modified.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroup(input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBSnapshot = "ModifyDBSnapshot"
// ModifyDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshot for more information on using the ModifyDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Updates a manual DB snapshot, which can be encrypted or not encrypted, with
// a new engine version.
//
// Amazon RDS supports upgrading DB snapshots for MySQL and Oracle.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshot(input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBSnapshotAttribute = "ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute"
// ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for more information on using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBSnapshotAttribute,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds an attribute and values to, or removes an attribute and values from,
// a manual DB snapshot.
//
// To share a manual DB snapshot with other AWS accounts, specify restore as
// the AttributeName and use the ValuesToAdd parameter to add a list of IDs
// of the AWS accounts that are authorized to restore the manual DB snapshot.
// Uses the value all to make the manual DB snapshot public, which means it
// can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts. Do not add the all value for
// any manual DB snapshots that contain private information that you don't want
// available to all AWS accounts. If the manual DB snapshot is encrypted, it
// can be shared, but only by specifying a list of authorized AWS account IDs
// for the ValuesToAdd parameter. You can't use all as a value for that parameter
// in this case.
//
// To view which AWS accounts have access to copy or restore a manual DB snapshot,
// or whether a manual DB snapshot public or private, use the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual
// DB snapshot with.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute(input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBSubnetGroup = "ModifyDBSubnetGroup"
// ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBSubnetGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBSubnetGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies an existing DB subnet group. DB subnet groups must contain at least
// one subnet in at least two AZs in the AWS Region.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets in a
// DB subnet groups.
//
// * ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse "SubnetAlreadyInUse"
// The DB subnet is already in use in the Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroup(input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSubnetGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyEventSubscription = "ModifyEventSubscription"
// ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyEventSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyEventSubscription for more information on using the ModifyEventSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyEventSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyEventSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies an existing RDS event notification subscription. Note that you can't
// modify the source identifiers using this call; to change source identifiers
// for a subscription, use the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription and RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
// calls.
//
// You can see a list of the event categories for a given SourceType in the
// Events (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyEventSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded"
// You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic"
// SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization"
// You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound"
// The SNS topic ARN does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound"
// The supplied category does not exist.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscription(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as ModifyEventSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyOptionGroup = "ModifyOptionGroup"
// ModifyOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyOptionGroup for more information on using the ModifyOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input *ModifyOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &ModifyOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies an existing option group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault"
// The option group is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroup(input *ModifyOptionGroupInput) (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyOptionGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opPromoteReadReplica = "PromoteReadReplica"
// PromoteReadReplicaRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the PromoteReadReplica operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See PromoteReadReplica for more information on using the PromoteReadReplica
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the PromoteReadReplicaRequest method.
// req, resp := client.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplica
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input *PromoteReadReplicaInput) (req *request.Request, output *PromoteReadReplicaOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opPromoteReadReplica,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &PromoteReadReplicaInput{}
}
output = &PromoteReadReplicaOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// PromoteReadReplica API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Promotes a Read Replica DB instance to a standalone DB instance.
//
// We recommend that you enable automated backups on your Read Replica before
// promoting the Read Replica. This ensures that no backup is taken during the
// promotion process. Once the instance is promoted to a primary instance, backups
// are taken based on your backup settings.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation PromoteReadReplica for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplica
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplica(input *PromoteReadReplicaInput) (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// PromoteReadReplicaWithContext is the same as PromoteReadReplica with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See PromoteReadReplica for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PromoteReadReplicaInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opPromoteReadReplicaDBCluster = "PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster"
// PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for more information on using the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opPromoteReadReplicaDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Promotes a Read Replica DB cluster to a standalone DB cluster.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster(input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext is the same as PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opPurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering = "PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering"
// PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for more information on using the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest method.
// req, resp := client.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering
func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opPurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput{}
}
output = &PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Purchases a reserved DB instance offering.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound"
// Specified offering does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "ReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a reservation with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault "ReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would exceed the user's DB Instance quota.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering
func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering(input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext is the same as PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRebootDBInstance = "RebootDBInstance"
// RebootDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RebootDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RebootDBInstance for more information on using the RebootDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RebootDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RebootDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RebootDBInstance
func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstanceRequest(input *RebootDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RebootDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRebootDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RebootDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &RebootDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RebootDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// You might need to reboot your DB instance, usually for maintenance reasons.
// For example, if you make certain modifications, or if you change the DB parameter
// group associated with the DB instance, you must reboot the instance for the
// changes to take effect.
//
// Rebooting a DB instance restarts the database engine service. Rebooting a
// DB instance results in a momentary outage, during which the DB instance status
// is set to rebooting.
//
// For more information about rebooting, see Rebooting a DB Instance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_RebootInstance.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RebootDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RebootDBInstance
func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstance(input *RebootDBInstanceInput) (*RebootDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RebootDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RebootDBInstanceWithContext is the same as RebootDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RebootDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RebootDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RebootDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RebootDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveRoleFromDBCluster = "RemoveRoleFromDBCluster"
// RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveRoleFromDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for more information on using the RemoveRoleFromDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBCluster
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveRoleFromDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// RemoveRoleFromDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Disassociates an Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from an Aurora
// DB cluster. For more information, see Authorizing Amazon Aurora to Access
// Other AWS Services On Your Behalf (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Authorizing.AWSServices.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterRoleNotFoundFault "DBClusterRoleNotFound"
// The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is not associated with
// the specified DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBCluster
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBCluster(input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext is the same as RemoveRoleFromDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription = "RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription"
// RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for more information on using the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Removes a source identifier from an existing RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound"
// The requested source could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription(input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext is the same as RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveTagsFromResource = "RemoveTagsFromResource"
// RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveTagsFromResource operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveTagsFromResource for more information on using the RemoveTagsFromResource
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveTagsFromResource
func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveTagsFromResource,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveTagsFromResourceInput{}
}
output = &RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Remove(query.UnmarshalHandler)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBackNamed(protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// RemoveTagsFromResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Removes metadata tags from an Amazon RDS resource.
//
// For an overview on tagging an Amazon RDS resource, see Tagging Amazon RDS
// Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveTagsFromResource for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveTagsFromResource
func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResource(input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) (*RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext is the same as RemoveTagsFromResource with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveTagsFromResource for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opResetDBClusterParameterGroup = "ResetDBClusterParameterGroup"
// ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ResetDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opResetDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ResetDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB cluster parameter group to the default value.
// To reset specific parameters submit a list of the following: ParameterName
// and ApplyMethod. To reset the entire DB cluster parameter group, specify
// the DBClusterParameterGroupName and ResetAllParameters parameters.
//
// When resetting the entire group, dynamic parameters are updated immediately
// and static parameters are set to pending-reboot to take effect on the next
// DB instance restart or RebootDBInstance request. You must call RebootDBInstance
// for every DB instance in your DB cluster that you want the updated static
// parameter to apply to.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroup(input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opResetDBParameterGroup = "ResetDBParameterGroup"
// ResetDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ResetDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ResetDBParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ResetDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opResetDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ResetDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ResetDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB parameter group to the engine/system default
// value. To reset specific parameters, provide a list of the following: ParameterName
// and ApplyMethod. To reset the entire DB parameter group, specify the DBParameterGroup
// name and ResetAllParameters parameters. When resetting the entire group,
// dynamic parameters are updated immediately and static parameters are set
// to pending-reboot to take effect on the next DB instance restart or RebootDBInstance
// request.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ResetDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroup(input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ResetDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBClusterFromS3 = "RestoreDBClusterFromS3"
// RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBClusterFromS3 operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterFromS3
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBClusterFromS3,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input{}
}
output = &RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromS3 API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates an Amazon Aurora DB cluster from data stored in an Amazon S3 bucket.
// Amazon RDS must be authorized to access the Amazon S3 bucket and the data
// must be created using the Percona XtraBackup utility as described in Migrating
// Data from MySQL by Using an Amazon S3 Bucket (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Migrate.MySQL.html#Aurora.Migrate.MySQL.S3).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault "InvalidS3BucketFault"
// The specified Amazon S3 bucket name could not be found or Amazon RDS is not
// authorized to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName
// and S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be
// able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3(input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterFromS3 with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot = "RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot"
// RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB cluster from a DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
//
// If a DB snapshot is specified, the target DB cluster is created from the
// source DB snapshot with a default configuration and default security group.
//
// If a DB cluster snapshot is specified, the target DB cluster is created from
// the source DB cluster restore point with the same configuration as the original
// source DB cluster, except that the new DB cluster is created with the default
// security group.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault"
// The DB cluster does not have enough capacity for the current operation.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be
// able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot(input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBClusterToPointInTime = "RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime"
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBClusterToPointInTime,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Restores a DB cluster to an arbitrary point in time. Users can restore to
// any point in time before LatestRestorableTime for up to BackupRetentionPeriod
// days. The target DB cluster is created from the source DB cluster with the
// same configuration as the original DB cluster, except that the new DB cluster
// is created with the default DB security group.
//
// This action only restores the DB cluster, not the DB instances for that DB
// cluster. You must invoke the CreateDBInstance action to create DB instances
// for the restored DB cluster, specifying the identifier of the restored DB
// cluster in DBClusterIdentifier. You can create DB instances only after the
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime action has completed and the DB cluster is
// available.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault"
// The DB cluster does not have enough capacity for the current operation.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be
// able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime(input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot = "RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot"
// RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB instance from a DB snapshot. The target database is created
// from the source database restore point with the most of original configuration
// with the default security group and the default DB parameter group. By default,
// the new DB instance is created as a single-AZ deployment except when the
// instance is a SQL Server instance that has an option group that is associated
// with mirroring; in this case, the instance becomes a mirrored AZ deployment
// and not a single-AZ deployment.
//
// If your intent is to replace your original DB instance with the new, restored
// DB instance, then rename your original DB instance before you call the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
// action. RDS does not allow two DB instances with the same name. Once you
// have renamed your original DB instance with a different identifier, then
// you can pass the original name of the DB instance as the DBInstanceIdentifier
// in the call to the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot action. The result is
// that you will replace the original DB instance with the DB instance created
// from the snapshot.
//
// If you are restoring from a shared manual DB snapshot, the DBSnapshotIdentifier
// must be the ARN of the shared DB snapshot.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBInstanceFromS3 = "RestoreDBInstanceFromS3"
// RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBInstanceFromS3,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input{}
}
output = &RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Amazon Relational Database Service (Amazon RDS) supports importing MySQL
// databases by using backup files. You can create a backup of your on-premises
// database, store it on Amazon Simple Storage Service (Amazon S3), and then
// restore the backup file onto a new Amazon RDS DB instance running MySQL.
// For more information, see Importing Data into an Amazon RDS MySQL DB Instance
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/MySQL.Procedural.Importing.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault "InvalidS3BucketFault"
// The specified Amazon S3 bucket name could not be found or Amazon RDS is not
// authorized to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName
// and S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime = "RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime"
// RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Restores a DB instance to an arbitrary point in time. You can restore to
// any point in time before the time identified by the LatestRestorableTime
// property. You can restore to a point up to the number of days specified by
// the BackupRetentionPeriod property.
//
// The target database is created with most of the original configuration, but
// in a system-selected availability zone, with the default security group,
// the default subnet group, and the default DB parameter group. By default,
// the new DB instance is created as a single-AZ deployment except when the
// instance is a SQL Server instance that has an option group that is associated
// with mirroring; in this case, the instance becomes a mirrored deployment
// and not a single-AZ deployment.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault "PointInTimeRestoreNotEnabled"
// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier refers to a DB instance with BackupRetentionPeriod
// equal to 0.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
// across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime(input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress = "RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress"
// RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput{}
}
output = &RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Revokes ingress from a DBSecurityGroup for previously authorized IP ranges
// or EC2 or VPC Security Groups. Required parameters for this API are one of
// CIDRIP, EC2SecurityGroupId for VPC, or (EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either
// EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opStartDBInstance = "StartDBInstance"
// StartDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the StartDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See StartDBInstance for more information on using the StartDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the StartDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.StartDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StartDBInstanceRequest(input *StartDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opStartDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &StartDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &StartDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// StartDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Starts a DB instance that was stopped using the AWS console, the stop-db-instance
// AWS CLI command, or the StopDBInstance action. For more information, see
// Stopping and Starting a DB instance in the AWS RDS user guide.
//
// This command does not apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation StartDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
// because users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
// DB security group.
//
// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
// behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// Error accessing KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StartDBInstance(input *StartDBInstanceInput) (*StartDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StartDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// StartDBInstanceWithContext is the same as StartDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See StartDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) StartDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StartDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opStopDBInstance = "StopDBInstance"
// StopDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the StopDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request complets
// successfuly.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See StopDBInstance for more information on using the StopDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the StopDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.StopDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StopDBInstanceRequest(input *StopDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opStopDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &StopDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &StopDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// StopDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Stops a DB instance. When you stop a DB instance, Amazon RDS retains the
// DB instance's metadata, including its endpoint, DB parameter group, and option
// group membership. Amazon RDS also retains the transaction logs so you can
// do a point-in-time restore if necessary. For more information, see Stopping
// and Starting a DB instance in the AWS RDS user guide.
//
// This command does not apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation StopDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StopDBInstance(input *StopDBInstanceInput) (*StopDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StopDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// StopDBInstanceWithContext is the same as StopDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See StopDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) StopDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StopDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// Describes a quota for an AWS account, for example, the number of DB instances
// allowed.
type AccountQuota struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the Amazon RDS quota for this AWS account.
AccountQuotaName *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum allowed value for the quota.
Max *int64 `type:"long"`
// The amount currently used toward the quota maximum.
Used *int64 `type:"long"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AccountQuota) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AccountQuota) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAccountQuotaName sets the AccountQuotaName field's value.
func (s *AccountQuota) SetAccountQuotaName(v string) *AccountQuota {
s.AccountQuotaName = &v
return s
}
// SetMax sets the Max field's value.
func (s *AccountQuota) SetMax(v int64) *AccountQuota {
s.Max = &v
return s
}
// SetUsed sets the Used field's value.
func (s *AccountQuota) SetUsed(v int64) *AccountQuota {
s.Used = &v
return s
}
type AddRoleToDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster to associate the IAM role with.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to associate with the Aurora
// DB cluster, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AuroraAccessRole.
//
// RoleArn is a required field
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddRoleToDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.RoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *AddRoleToDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *AddRoleToDBClusterInput {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
type AddRoleToDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the event source to be added.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If the source type is a DB instance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB security group, a DBSecurityGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB parameter group, a DBParameterGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB snapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be
// supplied.
//
// SourceIdentifier is a required field
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to add a source
// identifier to.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SourceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceIdentifier"))
}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type AddTagsToResourceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon RDS resource that the tags are added to. This value is an Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing
// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// ResourceName is a required field
ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tags to be assigned to the Amazon RDS resource.
//
// Tags is a required field
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddTagsToResourceInput"}
if s.ResourceName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName"))
}
if s.Tags == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Tags"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.
func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *AddTagsToResourceInput {
s.ResourceName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *AddTagsToResourceInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type AddTagsToResourceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The pending maintenance action to apply to this resource.
//
// Valid values: system-update, db-upgrade
//
// ApplyAction is a required field
ApplyAction *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A value that specifies the type of opt-in request, or undoes an opt-in request.
// An opt-in request of type immediate can't be undone.
//
// Valid values:
//
// * immediate - Apply the maintenance action immediately.
//
// * next-maintenance - Apply the maintenance action during the next maintenance
// window for the resource.
//
// * undo-opt-in - Cancel any existing next-maintenance opt-in requests.
//
// OptInType is a required field
OptInType *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the resource that the pending maintenance
// action applies to. For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing
// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// ResourceIdentifier is a required field
ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput"}
if s.ApplyAction == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ApplyAction"))
}
if s.OptInType == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptInType"))
}
if s.ResourceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetApplyAction sets the ApplyAction field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetApplyAction(v string) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput {
s.ApplyAction = &v
return s
}
// SetOptInType sets the OptInType field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetOptInType(v string) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput {
s.OptInType = &v
return s
}
// SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetResourceIdentifier(v string) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput {
s.ResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Describes the pending maintenance actions for a resource.
ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetResourcePendingMaintenanceActions sets the ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) SetResourcePendingMaintenanceActions(v *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput {
s.ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions = v
return s
}
type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The IP range to authorize.
CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB security group to add authorization to.
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Id of the EC2 security group to authorize. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId
// must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName
// or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// Name of the EC2 security group to authorize. For VPC DB security groups,
// EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and
// either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// AWS account number of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in the
// EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable
// value. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise,
// EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId
// must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.CIDRIP = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v
return s
}
type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup(v *DBSecurityGroup) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroup = v
return s
}
// Contains Availability Zone information.
//
// This data type is used as an element in the following data type:
//
// * OrderableDBInstanceOption
type AvailabilityZone struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the availability zone.
Name *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AvailabilityZone) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AvailabilityZone) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *AvailabilityZone) SetName(v string) *AvailabilityZone {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// A CA certificate for an AWS account.
type Certificate struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the certificate.
CertificateArn *string `type:"string"`
// The unique key that identifies a certificate.
CertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The type of the certificate.
CertificateType *string `type:"string"`
// The thumbprint of the certificate.
Thumbprint *string `type:"string"`
// The starting date from which the certificate is valid.
ValidFrom *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// The final date that the certificate continues to be valid.
ValidTill *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Certificate) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Certificate) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCertificateArn sets the CertificateArn field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateArn(v string) *Certificate {
s.CertificateArn = &v
return s
}
// SetCertificateIdentifier sets the CertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateIdentifier(v string) *Certificate {
s.CertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetCertificateType sets the CertificateType field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateType(v string) *Certificate {
s.CertificateType = &v
return s
}
// SetThumbprint sets the Thumbprint field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetThumbprint(v string) *Certificate {
s.Thumbprint = &v
return s
}
// SetValidFrom sets the ValidFrom field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetValidFrom(v time.Time) *Certificate {
s.ValidFrom = &v
return s
}
// SetValidTill sets the ValidTill field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetValidTill(v time.Time) *Certificate {
s.ValidTill = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the action DescribeDBEngineVersions.
type CharacterSet struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description of the character set.
CharacterSetDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the character set.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CharacterSet) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CharacterSet) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCharacterSetDescription sets the CharacterSetDescription field's value.
func (s *CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetDescription(v string) *CharacterSet {
s.CharacterSetDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CharacterSet {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch
// Logs for a specific DB instance or DB cluster.
type CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of log types to disable.
DisableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
// The list of log types to enable.
EnableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDisableLogTypes sets the DisableLogTypes field's value.
func (s *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) SetDisableLogTypes(v []*string) *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration {
s.DisableLogTypes = v
return s
}
// SetEnableLogTypes sets the EnableLogTypes field's value.
func (s *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) SetEnableLogTypes(v []*string) *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration {
s.EnableLogTypes = v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier or Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the source DB cluster parameter
// group. For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing an RDS Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid DB cluster parameter group.
//
// * If the source DB cluster parameter group is in the same AWS Region as
// the copy, specify a valid DB parameter group identifier, for example my-db-cluster-param-group,
// or a valid ARN.
//
// * If the source DB parameter group is in a different AWS Region than the
// copy, specify a valid DB cluster parameter group ARN, for example arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:123456789012:cluster-pg:custom-cluster-group1.
//
// SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A description for the copied DB cluster parameter group.
//
// TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription is a required field
TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the copied DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-cluster-param-group1
//
// TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription"))
}
if s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription sets the TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier sets the TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// action.
DBClusterParameterGroup *DBClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v *DBClusterParameterGroup) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the source DB cluster snapshot to the target DB
// cluster snapshot, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTags *bool `type:"boolean"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted DB cluster snapshot. The KMS key
// ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key
// alias for the KMS encryption key.
//
// If you copy an unencrypted DB cluster snapshot and specify a value for the
// KmsKeyId parameter, Amazon RDS encrypts the target DB cluster snapshot using
// the specified KMS encryption key.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from your AWS account, you can
// specify a value for KmsKeyId to encrypt the copy with a new KMS encryption
// key. If you don't specify a value for KmsKeyId, then the copy of the DB cluster
// snapshot is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB cluster snapshot.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot that is shared from another
// AWS account, then you must specify a value for KmsKeyId.
//
// To copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot to another AWS Region, you must
// set KmsKeyId to the KMS key ID you want to use to encrypt the copy of the
// DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys are
// specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use encryption
// keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot
// API action in the AWS Region that contains the source DB cluster snapshot
// to copy. The PreSignedUrl parameter must be used when copying an encrypted
// DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region.
//
// The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBSClusterSnapshot
// API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the
// encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. The pre-signed URL request must
// contain the following parameter values:
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the copy of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This
// is the same identifier for both the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action that
// is called in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the
// pre-signed URL.
//
// * DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that the DB cluster snapshot
// will be created in.
//
// * SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier
// for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must
// be in the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region.
// For example, if you are copying an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from
// the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
// looks like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster-snapshot:aurora-cluster1-snapshot-20161115.
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot to copy. This parameter is not
// case-sensitive.
//
// You can't copy an encrypted, shared DB cluster snapshot from one AWS Region
// to another.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid system snapshot in the "available" state.
//
// * If the source snapshot is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify
// a valid DB snapshot identifier.
//
// * If the source snapshot is in a different AWS Region than the copy, specify
// a valid DB cluster snapshot ARN. For more information, go to Copying
// a DB Snapshot or DB Cluster Snapshot (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html).
//
// Example: my-cluster-snapshot1
//
// SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The identifier of the new DB cluster snapshot to create from the source DB
// cluster snapshot. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster-snapshot2
//
// TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput"}
if s.SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCopyTags sets the CopyTags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags(v bool) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTags = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot(v *DBClusterSnapshot) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CopyDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier or ARN for the source DB parameter group. For information
// about creating an ARN, see Constructing an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN)
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid DB parameter group.
//
// * Must specify a valid DB parameter group identifier, for example my-db-param-group,
// or a valid ARN.
//
// SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A description for the copied DB parameter group.
//
// TargetDBParameterGroupDescription is a required field
TargetDBParameterGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the copied DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-db-parameter-group
//
// TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBParameterGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBParameterGroupDescription"))
}
if s.TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier sets the SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription sets the TargetDBParameterGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBParameterGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier sets the TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
DBParameterGroup *DBParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroup sets the DBParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) SetDBParameterGroup(v *DBParameterGroup) *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CopyDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the source DB snapshot to the target DB snapshot,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTags *bool `type:"boolean"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted DB snapshot. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
// encryption key.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from your AWS account, you can specify
// a value for this parameter to encrypt the copy with a new KMS encryption
// key. If you don't specify a value for this parameter, then the copy of the
// DB snapshot is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB snapshot.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB snapshot that is shared from another AWS account,
// then you must specify a value for this parameter.
//
// If you specify this parameter when you copy an unencrypted snapshot, the
// copy is encrypted.
//
// If you copy an encrypted snapshot to a different AWS Region, then you must
// specify a KMS key for the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys are
// specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use encryption
// keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of an option group to associate with the copy of the snapshot.
//
// Specify this option if you are copying a snapshot from one AWS Region to
// another, and your DB instance uses a nondefault option group. If your source
// DB instance uses Transparent Data Encryption for Oracle or Microsoft SQL
// Server, you must specify this option when copying across AWS Regions. For
// more information, see Option Group Considerations (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html#USER_CopySnapshot.Options).
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBSnapshot
// API action in the source AWS Region that contains the source DB snapshot
// to copy.
//
// You must specify this parameter when you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from
// another AWS Region by using the Amazon RDS API. You can specify the --source-region
// option instead of this parameter when you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from
// another AWS Region by using the AWS CLI.
//
// The presigned URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBSnapshot API action
// that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted
// DB snapshot to be copied. The presigned URL request must contain the following
// parameter values:
//
// * DestinationRegion - The AWS Region that the encrypted DB snapshot is
// copied to. This AWS Region is the same one where the CopyDBSnapshot action
// is called that contains this presigned URL.
//
// For example, if you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from the us-west-2 AWS
// Region to the us-east-1 AWS Region, then you call the CopyDBSnapshot action
// in the us-east-1 AWS Region and provide a presigned URL that contains
// a call to the CopyDBSnapshot action in the us-west-2 AWS Region. For this
// example, the DestinationRegion in the presigned URL must be set to the
// us-east-1 AWS Region.
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the copy of the DB snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This is the
// same identifier for both the CopyDBSnapshot action that is called in the
// destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the presigned URL.
//
//
// * SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier - The DB snapshot identifier for the encrypted
// snapshot to be copied. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are copying
// an encrypted DB snapshot from the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier
// looks like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20161115.
//
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the source DB snapshot.
//
// If the source snapshot is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify a valid
// DB snapshot identifier. For example, you might specify rds:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805.
//
// If the source snapshot is in a different AWS Region than the copy, specify
// a valid DB snapshot ARN. For example, you might specify arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805.
//
// If you are copying from a shared manual DB snapshot, this parameter must
// be the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the shared DB snapshot.
//
// If you are copying an encrypted snapshot this parameter must be in the ARN
// format for the source AWS Region, and must match the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier
// in the PreSignedUrl parameter.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid system snapshot in the "available" state.
//
// Example: rds:mydb-2012-04-02-00-01
//
// Example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805
//
// SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The identifier for the copy of the snapshot.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-db-snapshot
//
// TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCopyTags sets the CopyTags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags(v bool) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTags = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *CopyDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CopyOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier or ARN for the source option group. For information about
// creating an ARN, see Constructing an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid option group.
//
// * If the source option group is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify
// a valid option group identifier, for example my-option-group, or a valid
// ARN.
//
// * If the source option group is in a different AWS Region than the copy,
// specify a valid option group ARN, for example arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:og:special-options.
//
// SourceOptionGroupIdentifier is a required field
SourceOptionGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The description for the copied option group.
//
// TargetOptionGroupDescription is a required field
TargetOptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the copied option group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-option-group
//
// TargetOptionGroupIdentifier is a required field
TargetOptionGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyOptionGroupInput"}
if s.SourceOptionGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceOptionGroupIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetOptionGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetOptionGroupDescription"))
}
if s.TargetOptionGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetOptionGroupIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier sets the SourceOptionGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.SourceOptionGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetOptionGroupDescription sets the TargetOptionGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.TargetOptionGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier sets the TargetOptionGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.TargetOptionGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup(v *OptionGroup) *CopyOptionGroupOutput {
s.OptionGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster can be
// created in. For information on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions
// and Availability Zones (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. You must specify
// a minimum value of 1.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 1 to 35
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
// specified CharacterSet.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with this DB cluster.
// If this argument is omitted, default.aurora5.6 is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
// default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The name for your database of up to 64 alpha-numeric characters. If you do
// not provide a name, Amazon RDS will not create a database in the DB cluster
// you are creating.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
//
// Valid Values: aurora, aurora-postgresql
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use.
//
// Aurora
//
// Example: 5.6.10a
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
//
// If an encryption key is not specified in KmsKeyId:
//
// * If ReplicationSourceIdentifier identifies an encrypted source, then
// Amazon RDS will use the encryption key used to encrypt the source. Otherwise,
// Amazon RDS will use your default encryption key.
//
// * If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true and ReplicationSourceIdentifier
// is not specified, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption key.
//
// AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your AWS
// account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
//
// If you create a Read Replica of an encrypted DB cluster in another AWS Region,
// you must set KmsKeyId to a KMS key ID that is valid in the destination AWS
// Region. This key is used to encrypt the Read Replica in that AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master database user. This password can contain any
// printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the master user for the DB cluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
// specified option group.
//
// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. The option group
// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the instances in the DB cluster accept connections.
//
// Default: 3306 if engine is set as aurora or 5432 if set to aurora-postgresql.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CreateDBCluster
// action to be called in the source AWS Region where the DB cluster is replicated
// from. You only need to specify PreSignedUrl when you are performing cross-region
// replication from an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CreateDBCluster API action
// that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted
// DB cluster to be copied.
//
// The pre-signed URL request must contain the following parameter values:
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the copy of the DB cluster in the destination AWS Region. This should
// refer to the same KMS key for both the CreateDBCluster action that is
// called in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the
// pre-signed URL.
//
// * DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that Aurora Read Replica
// will be created in.
//
// * ReplicationSourceIdentifier - The DB cluster identifier for the encrypted
// DB cluster to be copied. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are copying
// an encrypted DB cluster from the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your ReplicationSourceIdentifier
// would look like Example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster:aurora-cluster1.
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
// the time blocks available, see Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the source DB instance or DB cluster if
// this DB cluster is created as a Read Replica.
ReplicationSourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB cluster.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngine(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetReplicationSourceIdentifier sets the ReplicationSourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.ReplicationSourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *CreateDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
//
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB cluster parameter group family name. A DB cluster parameter group
// can be associated with one and only one DB cluster parameter group family,
// and can be applied only to a DB cluster running a database engine and engine
// version compatible with that DB cluster parameter group family.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The description for the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Description is a required field
Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.Description == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// action.
DBClusterParameterGroup *DBClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v *DBClusterParameterGroup) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster to create a snapshot for. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot. This parameter is stored as a
// lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1-snapshot1
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tags to be assigned to the DB cluster snapshot.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot(v *DBClusterSnapshot) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The amount of storage (in gibibytes) to allocate for the DB instance.
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Aurora cluster volumes automatically grow as the amount of
// data in your database increases, though you are only charged for the space
// that you use in an Aurora cluster volume.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 10 to 3072.
//
// SQL Server
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2):
//
// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 16384.
//
// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1):
//
// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 16384.
//
// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard):
//
// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 1024.
//
// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 20 to 1024.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window.
//
// Default: true
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in. For information
// on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
// Region.
//
// Example: us-east-1d
//
// Constraint: The AvailabilityZone parameter can't be specified if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true. The specified Availability Zone must be in the
// same AWS Region as the current endpoint.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. Setting this
// parameter to a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to
// 0 disables automated backups.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The retention period for automated backups is managed by
// the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 0 to 35
//
// * Cannot be set to 0 if the DB instance is a source to Read Replicas
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// For supported engines, indicates that the DB instance should be associated
// with the specified CharacterSet.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The character set is managed by the DB cluster. For more
// information, see CreateDBCluster.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster that the instance will belong to.
//
// For information on creating a DB cluster, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Type: String
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// DBInstanceClass is a required field
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The meaning of this parameter differs according to the database engine you
// use.
//
// Type: String
//
// MySQL
//
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
// parameter is not specified, no database is created in the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
//
// * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
//
// MariaDB
//
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
// parameter is not specified, no database is created in the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
//
// * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
// parameter is not specified, the default "postgres" database is created in
// the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or underscores.
//
// * Must begin with a letter or an underscore. Subsequent characters can
// be letters, underscores, or digits (0-9).
//
// * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
//
// Oracle
//
// The Oracle System ID (SID) of the created DB instance. If you specify null,
// the default value ORCL is used. You can't specify the string NULL, or any
// other reserved word, for DBName.
//
// Default: ORCL
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Cannot be longer than 8 characters
//
// SQL Server
//
// Not applicable. Must be null.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// The name of the database to create when the primary instance of the DB cluster
// is created. If this parameter is not specified, no database is created in
// the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
//
// * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
// this argument is omitted, the default DBParameterGroup for the specified
// engine is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A list of DB security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Default: The default DB security group for the database engine.
DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB instance.
//
// If there is no DB subnet group, then it is a non-VPC DB instance.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the Active Directory Domain to create the instance in.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
// Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of log types that need to be enabled for exporting to CloudWatch
// Logs.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines:
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Mapping AWS IAM accounts to database accounts is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MySQL
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for this instance.
//
// Not every database engine is available for every AWS Region.
//
// Valid Values:
//
// * aurora
//
// * aurora-postgresql
//
// * mariadb
//
// * mysql
//
// * oracle-ee
//
// * oracle-se2
//
// * oracle-se1
//
// * oracle-se
//
// * postgres
//
// * sqlserver-ee
//
// * sqlserver-se
//
// * sqlserver-ex
//
// * sqlserver-web
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use.
//
// The following are the database engines and major and minor versions that
// are available with Amazon RDS. Not every database engine is available for
// every AWS Region.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The version number of the database engine to be used by the
// DB instance is managed by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MariaDB
//
// * 10.2.11 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// 10.1.26 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.1.23 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.1.19 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.1.14 (supported in all AWS Regions except us-east-2)
//
// * 10.0.32 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.0.31 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.0.28 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.0.24 (supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// * 10.0.17 (supported in all AWS Regions except us-east-2, ca-central-1,
// eu-west-2)
//
// Microsoft SQL Server 2017
//
// * 14.00.1000.169.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// Microsoft SQL Server 2016
//
// * 13.00.4451.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// * 13.00.4422.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// * 13.00.2164.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// Microsoft SQL Server 2014
//
// * 12.00.5546.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// * 12.00.5000.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// * 12.00.4422.0.v1 (supported for all editions except Enterprise Edition,
// and all AWS Regions except ca-central-1 and eu-west-2)
//
// Microsoft SQL Server 2012
//
// * 11.00.6594.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// * 11.00.6020.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
//
// * 11.00.5058.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
// us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
//
// * 11.00.2100.60.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
// us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
//
// Microsoft SQL Server 2008 R2
//
// * 10.50.6529.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
// us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
//
// * 10.50.6000.34.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
// us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
//
// * 10.50.2789.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
// us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
//
// MySQL
//
// * 5.7.19 (supported in all AWS regions)
//
// * 5.7.17 (supported in all AWS regions)
//
// * 5.7.16 (supported in all AWS regions)
//
// 5.6.37(supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// 5.6.35(supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// 5.6.34(supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// 5.6.29(supported in all AWS Regions)
//
// 5.6.27
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
// initially allocated for the DB instance. For information about valid Iops
// values, see see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to Improve Performance
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS).
//
// Constraints: Must be a multiple between 1 and 50 of the storage amount for
// the DB instance. Must also be an integer multiple of 1000. For example, if
// the size of your DB instance is 500 GiB, then your Iops value can be 2000,
// 3000, 4000, or 5000.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB instance.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB instance with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB instance, then you can
// use the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The KMS key identifier is managed by the DB cluster. For
// more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// License model information for this DB instance.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master user. The password can include any printable
// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The password for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 30 characters.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The name for the master user.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The name for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for MariaDB.
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for SQL Server.
//
// * Must be 1 to 128 letters or numbers.
//
// * The first character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for MySQL.
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for Oracle.
//
// * Must be 1 to 30 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for PostgreSQL.
//
// * Must be 1 to 63 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to Setting Up and Enabling
// Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.OS.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.Enabling).
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. You can't set the
// AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ parameter is set to true.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates that the DB instance should be associated with the specified option
// group.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// MySQL
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// MariaDB
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Default: 5432
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Oracle
//
// Default: 1521
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// SQL Server
//
// Default: 1433
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535 except for 1434, 3389, 47001, 49152, and 49152 through
// 49156.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter. For more
// information, see The Backup Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.html#USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.BackupWindow).
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The daily time range for creating automated backups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred DB Instance Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow).
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The time range each week during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC). For more information, see Amazon RDS Maintenance
// Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#Concepts.DBMaintenance).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
//
// Default: 1
//
// Valid Values: 0 - 15
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
//
// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
//
// * Default VPC: true
//
// * VPC: false
//
// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is encrypted.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The encryption for DB instances is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Default: false
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the DB instance. The time zone parameter is currently supported
// only by Microsoft SQL Server (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_SQLServer.html#SQLServer.Concepts.General.TimeZone).
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The associated list of EC2 VPC security groups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Default: The default EC2 VPC security group for the DB subnet group's VPC.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceClass == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceClass"))
}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomain(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngine(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetIops(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTimezone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *CreateDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to the Read
// Replica during the maintenance window.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Amazon EC2 Availability Zone that the Read Replica is created in.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
// Region.
//
// Example: us-east-1d
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the Read Replica to snapshots of the Read Replica,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the Read Replica, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance identifier of the Read Replica. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB instance. This parameter is stored as a lowercase
// string.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies a DB subnet group for the DB instance. The new DB instance is created
// in the VPC associated with the DB subnet group. If no DB subnet group is
// specified, then the new DB instance is not created in a VPC.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can only be specified if the source DB instance identifier specifies
// a DB instance in another AWS Region.
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// * The specified DB subnet group must be in the same AWS Region in which
// the operation is running.
//
// * All Read Replicas in one AWS Region that are created from the same source
// DB instance must either:>
//
// Specify DB subnet groups from the same VPC. All these Read Replicas are created
// in the same VPC.
//
// Not specify a DB subnet group. All these Read Replicas are created outside
// of any VPC.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the new DB instance is to export to CloudWatch Logs.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// * Aurora 5.6 or higher.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the read replica, and otherwise false.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
// initially allocated for the DB instance.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted Read Replica. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
// encryption key.
//
// If you specify this parameter when you create a Read Replica from an unencrypted
// DB instance, the Read Replica is encrypted.
//
// If you create an encrypted Read Replica in the same AWS Region as the source
// DB instance, then you do not have to specify a value for this parameter.
// The Read Replica is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB instance.
//
// If you create an encrypted Read Replica in a different AWS Region, then you
// must specify a KMS key for the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys
// are specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use
// encryption keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the Read Replica. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to To create an IAM role
// for Amazon RDS Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.IAMRole).
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the read replica is in a Multi-AZ deployment.
//
// You can create a Read Replica as a Multi-AZ DB instance. RDS creates a standby
// of your replica in another Availability Zone for failover support for the
// replica. Creating your Read Replica as a Multi-AZ DB instance is independent
// of whether the source database is a Multi-AZ DB instance.
//
// Currently PostgreSQL Read Replicas can only be created as single-AZ DB instances.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The option group the DB instance is associated with. If omitted, the default
// option group for the engine specified is used.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The port number that the DB instance uses for connections.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// API action in the source AWS Region that contains the source DB instance.
//
// You must specify this parameter when you create an encrypted Read Replica
// from another AWS Region by using the Amazon RDS API. You can specify the
// --source-region option instead of this parameter when you create an encrypted
// Read Replica from another AWS Region by using the AWS CLI.
//
// The presigned URL must be a valid request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the
// encrypted source DB instance. The presigned URL request must contain the
// following parameter values:
//
// * DestinationRegion - The AWS Region that the encrypted Read Replica is
// created in. This AWS Region is the same one where the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// action is called that contains this presigned URL.
//
// For example, if you create an encrypted DB instance in the us-west-1 AWS
// Region, from a source DB instance in the us-east-2 AWS Region, then you
// call the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica action in the us-east-1 AWS Region
// and provide a presigned URL that contains a call to the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// action in the us-west-2 AWS Region. For this example, the DestinationRegion
// in the presigned URL must be set to the us-east-1 AWS Region.
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the Read Replica in the destination AWS Region. This is the same identifier
// for both the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica action that is called in the
// destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the presigned URL.
//
//
// * SourceDBInstanceIdentifier - The DB instance identifier for the encrypted
// DB instance to be replicated. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are creating
// an encrypted Read Replica from a DB instance in the us-west-2 AWS Region,
// then your SourceDBInstanceIdentifier looks like the following example:
// arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:instance:mysql-instance1-20161115.
//
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
//
// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
//
// * Default VPC:true
//
// * VPC:false
//
// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The identifier of the DB instance that will act as the source for the Read
// Replica. Each DB instance can have up to five Read Replicas.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be the identifier of an existing MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL
// DB instance.
//
// * Can specify a DB instance that is a MySQL Read Replica only if the source
// is running MySQL 5.6.
//
// * Can specify a DB instance that is a PostgreSQL DB instance only if the
// source is running PostgreSQL 9.3.5 or later (9.4.7 and higher for cross-region
// replication).
//
// * The specified DB instance must have automatic backups enabled, its backup
// retention period must be greater than 0.
//
// * If the source DB instance is in the same AWS Region as the Read Replica,
// specify a valid DB instance identifier.
//
// * If the source DB instance is in a different AWS Region than the Read
// Replica, specify a valid DB instance ARN. For more information, go to
// Constructing a Amazon RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the Read Replica.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetIops(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the SourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetStorageType(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type CreateDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB parameter group family name. A DB parameter group can be associated
// with one and only one DB parameter group family, and can be applied only
// to a DB instance running a database engine and engine version compatible
// with that DB parameter group family.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The description for the DB parameter group.
//
// Description is a required field
Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Description == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
DBParameterGroup *DBParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroup sets the DBParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) SetDBParameterGroup(v *DBParameterGroup) *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSecurityGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description for the DB security group.
//
// DBSecurityGroupDescription is a required field
DBSecurityGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name for the DB security group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// * Must not be "Default"
//
// Example: mysecuritygroup
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBSecurityGroupInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupDescription"))
}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupDescription sets the DBSecurityGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription(v string) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup(v *DBSecurityGroup) *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB instance that you want to create the snapshot of.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-snapshot-id
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *CreateDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSubnetGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description for the DB subnet group.
//
// DBSubnetGroupDescription is a required field
DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name for the DB subnet group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints: Must contain no more than 255 letters, numbers, periods, underscores,
// spaces, or hyphens. Must not be default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
//
// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The EC2 Subnet IDs for the DB subnet group.
//
// SubnetIds is a required field
SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBSubnetGroupInput"}
if s.DBSubnetGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupDescription"))
}
if s.DBSubnetGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupName"))
}
if s.SubnetIds == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubnetIds"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds(v []*string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.SubnetIds = v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput {
s.DBSubnetGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateEventSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A Boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription, set to false to
// create the subscription but not active it.
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of event categories for a SourceType that you want to subscribe to.
// You can see a list of the categories for a given SourceType in the Events
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic created for event notification.
// The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic and subscribe to
// it.
//
// SnsTopicArn is a required field
SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The list of identifiers of the event sources for which events are returned.
// If not specified, then all sources are included in the response. An identifier
// must begin with a letter and must contain only ASCII letters, digits, and
// hyphens; it can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If SourceIds are supplied, SourceType must also be provided.
//
// * If the source type is a DB instance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB security group, a DBSecurityGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB parameter group, a DBParameterGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB snapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be
// supplied.
SourceIds []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"`
// The type of source that is generating the events. For example, if you want
// to be notified of events generated by a DB instance, you would set this parameter
// to db-instance. if this value is not specified, all events are returned.
//
// Valid values: db-instance | db-cluster | db-parameter-group | db-security-group
// | db-snapshot | db-cluster-snapshot
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the subscription.
//
// Constraints: The name must be less than 255 characters.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateEventSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SnsTopicArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnsTopicArn"))
}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled(v bool) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.Enabled = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SnsTopicArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIds sets the SourceIds field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIds(v []*string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceIds = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateEventSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type CreateOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the name of the engine that this option group should be associated
// with.
//
// EngineName is a required field
EngineName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies the major version of the engine that this option group should be
// associated with.
//
// MajorEngineVersion is a required field
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The description of the option group.
//
// OptionGroupDescription is a required field
OptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies the name of the option group to be created.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: myoptiongroup
//
// OptionGroupName is a required field
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateOptionGroupInput"}
if s.EngineName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EngineName"))
}
if s.MajorEngineVersion == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MajorEngineVersion"))
}
if s.OptionGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupDescription"))
}
if s.OptionGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetEngineName(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupDescription sets the OptionGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup(v *OptionGroup) *CreateOptionGroupOutput {
s.OptionGroup = v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
type DBCluster struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// For all database engines except Amazon Aurora, AllocatedStorage specifies
// the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB). For Aurora, AllocatedStorage
// always returns 1, because Aurora DB cluster storage size is not fixed, but
// instead automatically adjusts as needed.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides a list of the AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that
// are associated with the DB cluster. IAM roles that are associated with a
// DB cluster grant permission for the DB cluster to access other AWS services
// on your behalf.
AssociatedRoles []*DBClusterRole `locationNameList:"DBClusterRole" type:"list"`
// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster
// can be created in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// Specifies the number of days for which automatic DB snapshots are retained.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If present, specifies the name of the character set that this cluster is
// associated with.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// Identifies the clone group to which the DB cluster is associated.
CloneGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the time when the DB cluster was created, in Universal Coordinated
// Time (UTC).
ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster.
DBClusterArn *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a user-supplied DB cluster identifier. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB cluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the list of instances that make up the DB cluster.
DBClusterMembers []*DBClusterMember `locationNameList:"DBClusterMember" type:"list"`
// Provides the list of option group memberships for this DB cluster.
DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships []*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus `locationNameList:"DBClusterOptionGroup" type:"list"`
// Specifies the name of the DB cluster parameter group for the DB cluster.
DBClusterParameterGroup *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies information on the subnet group associated with the DB cluster,
// including the name, description, and subnets in the subnet group.
DBSubnetGroup *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the name of the initial database of this DB cluster that was provided
// at create time, if one was specified when the DB cluster was created. This
// same name is returned for the life of the DB cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the DB cluster. This identifier
// is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS key for the DB
// cluster is accessed.
DbClusterResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the earliest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
// restore.
EarliestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Specifies the connection endpoint for the primary instance of the DB cluster.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the ID that Amazon Route 53 assigns when you create a hosted zone.
HostedZoneId *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
// DB cluster.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the latest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
// restore.
LatestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Contains the master username for the DB cluster.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster has instances in multiple Availability Zones.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the progress of the operation as a percentage.
PercentProgress *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the port that the database engine is listening on.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the daily time range during which automated backups are created
// if automated backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur,
// in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Contains one or more identifiers of the Read Replicas associated with this
// DB cluster.
ReadReplicaIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaIdentifier" type:"list"`
// The reader endpoint for the DB cluster. The reader endpoint for a DB cluster
// load-balances connections across the Aurora Replicas that are available in
// a DB cluster. As clients request new connections to the reader endpoint,
// Aurora distributes the connection requests among the Aurora Replicas in the
// DB cluster. This functionality can help balance your read workload across
// multiple Aurora Replicas in your DB cluster.
//
// If a failover occurs, and the Aurora Replica that you are connected to is
// promoted to be the primary instance, your connection is dropped. To continue
// sending your read workload to other Aurora Replicas in the cluster, you can
// then reconnect to the reader endpoint.
ReaderEndpoint *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the identifier of the source DB cluster if this DB cluster is a
// Read Replica.
ReplicationSourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the current state of this DB cluster.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides a list of VPC security groups that the DB cluster belongs to.
VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBCluster) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBCluster) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAssociatedRoles sets the AssociatedRoles field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetAssociatedRoles(v []*DBClusterRole) *DBCluster {
s.AssociatedRoles = v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *DBCluster {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *DBCluster {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCloneGroupId sets the CloneGroupId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCloneGroupId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.CloneGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.ClusterCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterArn sets the DBClusterArn field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterArn(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterMembers sets the DBClusterMembers field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterMembers(v []*DBClusterMember) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterMembers = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships sets the DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships(v []*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterParameterGroup = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBSubnetGroup(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBSubnetGroup = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDbClusterResourceId sets the DbClusterResourceId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDbClusterResourceId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DbClusterResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetEarliestRestorableTime sets the EarliestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEarliestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.EarliestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEndpoint(v string) *DBCluster {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEngine(v string) *DBCluster {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBCluster {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetHostedZoneId sets the HostedZoneId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetHostedZoneId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.HostedZoneId = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLatestRestorableTime sets the LatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetLatestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.LatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBCluster {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPercentProgress(v string) *DBCluster {
s.PercentProgress = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPort(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *DBCluster {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *DBCluster {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaIdentifiers field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetReadReplicaIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBCluster {
s.ReadReplicaIdentifiers = v
return s
}
// SetReaderEndpoint sets the ReaderEndpoint field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetReaderEndpoint(v string) *DBCluster {
s.ReaderEndpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetReplicationSourceIdentifier sets the ReplicationSourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier(v string) *DBCluster {
s.ReplicationSourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetStatus(v string) *DBCluster {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *DBCluster {
s.VpcSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// Contains information about an instance that is part of a DB cluster.
type DBClusterMember struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the status of the DB cluster parameter group for this member of
// the DB cluster.
DBClusterParameterGroupStatus *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the instance identifier for this member of the DB cluster.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Value that is true if the cluster member is the primary instance for the
// DB cluster and false otherwise.
IsClusterWriter *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterMember) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterMember) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus sets the DBClusterParameterGroupStatus field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus(v string) *DBClusterMember {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupStatus = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterMember {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetIsClusterWriter sets the IsClusterWriter field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetIsClusterWriter(v bool) *DBClusterMember {
s.IsClusterWriter = &v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *DBClusterMember {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// Contains status information for a DB cluster option group.
type DBClusterOptionGroupStatus struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the name of the DB cluster option group.
DBClusterOptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of the DB cluster option group.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterOptionGroupName sets the DBClusterOptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetDBClusterOptionGroupName(v string) *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus {
s.DBClusterOptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// action.
type DBClusterParameterGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster parameter group.
DBClusterParameterGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB cluster parameter group.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group family that this DB cluster parameter
// group is compatible with.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the customer-specified description for this DB cluster parameter
// group.
Description *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn sets the DBClusterParameterGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDescription(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
type DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// Describes an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role that is associated
// with a DB cluster.
type DBClusterRole struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role that is associated with the
// DB cluster.
RoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Describes the state of association between the IAM role and the DB cluster.
// The Status property returns one of the following values:
//
// * ACTIVE - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB cluster and can
// be used to access other AWS services on your behalf.
//
// * PENDING - the IAM role ARN is being associated with the DB cluster.
//
// * INVALID - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB cluster, but the
// DB cluster is unable to assume the IAM role in order to access other AWS
// services on your behalf.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterRole) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterRole) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterRole) SetRoleArn(v string) *DBClusterRole {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterRole) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterRole {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
type DBClusterSnapshot struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster
// snapshot can be restored in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// Specifies the time when the DB cluster was created, in Universal Coordinated
// Time (UTC).
ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Specifies the DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster that this DB cluster
// snapshot was created from.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster snapshot.
DBClusterSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the identifier for the DB cluster snapshot.
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the version of the database engine for this DB cluster snapshot.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
// DB cluster snapshot.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the license model information for this DB cluster snapshot.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the master username for the DB cluster snapshot.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the percentage of the estimated data that has been transferred.
PercentProgress *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the port that the DB cluster was listening on at the time of the
// snapshot.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated Time
// (UTC).
SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Provides the type of the DB cluster snapshot.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
// If the DB cluster snapshot was copied from a source DB cluster snapshot,
// the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the source DB cluster snapshot, otherwise,
// a null value.
SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of this DB cluster snapshot.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster snapshot is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB cluster snapshot.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshot) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshot) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.ClusterCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotArn sets the DBClusterSnapshotArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotArn(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.DBClusterSnapshotArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngine(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetPercentProgress(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.PercentProgress = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetPort(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.SnapshotCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn sets the SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Contains the name and values of a manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
type DBClusterSnapshotAttribute struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
//
// The attribute named restore refers to the list of AWS accounts that have
// permission to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information,
// see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
AttributeName *string `type:"string"`
// The value(s) for the manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
//
// If the AttributeName field is set to restore, then this element returns a
// list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the
// manual DB cluster snapshot. If a value of all is in the list, then the manual
// DB cluster snapshot is public and available for any AWS account to copy or
// restore.
AttributeValues []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName(v string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeValues = v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
type DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of attributes and values for the manual DB cluster snapshot.
DBClusterSnapshotAttributes []*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute `locationNameList:"DBClusterSnapshotAttribute" type:"list"`
// The identifier of the manual DB cluster snapshot that the attributes apply
// to.
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributes sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributes field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributes(v []*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBClusterSnapshotAttributes = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the action DescribeDBEngineVersions.
type DBEngineVersion struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description of the database engine.
DBEngineDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The description of the database engine version.
DBEngineVersionDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group family for the database engine.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// The default character set for new instances of this engine version, if the
// CharacterSetName parameter of the CreateDBInstance API is not specified.
DefaultCharacterSet *CharacterSet `type:"structure"`
// The name of the database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The version number of the database engine.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The types of logs that the database engine has available for export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
ExportableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
// A list of the character sets supported by this engine for the CharacterSetName
// parameter of the CreateDBInstance action.
SupportedCharacterSets []*CharacterSet `locationNameList:"CharacterSet" type:"list"`
// A list of the time zones supported by this engine for the Timezone parameter
// of the CreateDBInstance action.
SupportedTimezones []*Timezone `locationNameList:"Timezone" type:"list"`
// A value that indicates whether the engine version supports exporting the
// log types specified by ExportableLogTypes to CloudWatch Logs.
SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of engine versions that this database engine version can be upgraded
// to.
ValidUpgradeTarget []*UpgradeTarget `locationNameList:"UpgradeTarget" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBEngineVersion) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBEngineVersion) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBEngineDescription sets the DBEngineDescription field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineDescription(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DBEngineDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBEngineVersionDescription sets the DBEngineVersionDescription field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineVersionDescription(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DBEngineVersionDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultCharacterSet sets the DefaultCharacterSet field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDefaultCharacterSet(v *CharacterSet) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DefaultCharacterSet = v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetEngine(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetExportableLogTypes sets the ExportableLogTypes field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetExportableLogTypes(v []*string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.ExportableLogTypes = v
return s
}
// SetSupportedCharacterSets sets the SupportedCharacterSets field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedCharacterSets(v []*CharacterSet) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportedCharacterSets = v
return s
}
// SetSupportedTimezones sets the SupportedTimezones field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedTimezones(v []*Timezone) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportedTimezones = v
return s
}
// SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs sets the SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs(v bool) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs = &v
return s
}
// SetValidUpgradeTarget sets the ValidUpgradeTarget field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetValidUpgradeTarget(v []*UpgradeTarget) *DBEngineVersion {
s.ValidUpgradeTarget = v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
type DBInstance struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size specified in gibibytes.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates that minor version patches are applied automatically.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the name of the Availability Zone the DB instance is located in.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the number of days for which automatic DB snapshots are retained.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The identifier of the CA certificate for this DB instance.
CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// If present, specifies the name of the character set that this instance is
// associated with.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether tags are copied from the DB instance to snapshots of the
// DB instance.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If the DB instance is a member of a DB cluster, contains the name of the
// DB cluster that the DB instance is a member of.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB instance.
DBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the name of the compute and memory capacity class of the DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a user-supplied database identifier. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB instance.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the current state of this database.
DBInstanceStatus *string `type:"string"`
// The meaning of this parameter differs according to the database engine you
// use. For example, this value returns MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL information
// when returning values from CreateDBInstanceReadReplica since Read Replicas
// are only supported for these engines.
//
// MySQL, MariaDB, SQL Server, PostgreSQL
//
// Contains the name of the initial database of this instance that was provided
// at create time, if one was specified when the DB instance was created. This
// same name is returned for the life of the DB instance.
//
// Type: String
//
// Oracle
//
// Contains the Oracle System ID (SID) of the created DB instance. Not shown
// when the returned parameters do not apply to an Oracle DB instance.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the list of DB parameter groups applied to this DB instance.
DBParameterGroups []*DBParameterGroupStatus `locationNameList:"DBParameterGroup" type:"list"`
// Provides List of DB security group elements containing only DBSecurityGroup.Name
// and DBSecurityGroup.Status subelements.
DBSecurityGroups []*DBSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// Specifies information on the subnet group associated with the DB instance,
// including the name, description, and subnets in the subnet group.
DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the port that the DB instance listens on. If the DB instance is
// part of a DB cluster, this can be a different port than the DB cluster port.
DbInstancePort *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the DB instance. This identifier
// is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS key for the DB
// instance is accessed.
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// The Active Directory Domain membership records associated with the DB instance.
DomainMemberships []*DomainMembership `locationNameList:"DomainMembership" type:"list"`
// A list of log types that this DB instance is configured to export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// Specifies the connection endpoint.
Endpoint *Endpoint `type:"structure"`
// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB instance.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon CloudWatch Logs log stream that
// receives the Enhanced Monitoring metrics data for the DB instance.
EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
//
// IAM database authentication can be enabled for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// * Aurora 5.6 or higher. To enable IAM database authentication for Aurora,
// see DBCluster Type.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the date and time the DB instance was created.
InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Specifies the Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
// DB instance.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the latest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
// restore.
LatestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// License model information for this DB instance.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the master username for the DB instance.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance.
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the list of option group memberships for this DB instance.
OptionGroupMemberships []*OptionGroupMembership `locationNameList:"OptionGroupMembership" type:"list"`
// Specifies that changes to the DB instance are pending. This element is only
// included when changes are pending. Specific changes are identified by subelements.
PendingModifiedValues *PendingModifiedValues `type:"structure"`
// True if Performance Insights is enabled for the DB instance, and otherwise
// false.
PerformanceInsightsEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the daily time range during which automated backups are created
// if automated backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur,
// in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
//
// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
//
// * Default VPC:true
//
// * VPC:false
//
// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Contains one or more identifiers of Aurora DB clusters that are Read Replicas
// of this DB instance.
ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifier" type:"list"`
// Contains one or more identifiers of the Read Replicas associated with this
// DB instance.
ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifier" type:"list"`
// Contains the identifier of the source DB instance if this DB instance is
// a Read Replica.
ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// If present, specifies the name of the secondary Availability Zone for a DB
// instance with multi-AZ support.
SecondaryAvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The status of a Read Replica. If the instance is not a Read Replica, this
// is blank.
StatusInfos []*DBInstanceStatusInfo `locationNameList:"DBInstanceStatusInfo" type:"list"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type associated with DB instance.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which the instance is associated for TDE
// encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the DB instance. In most cases, the Timezone element is
// empty. Timezone content appears only for Microsoft SQL Server DB instances
// that were created with a time zone specified.
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a list of VPC security group elements that the DB instance belongs
// to.
VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBInstance) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBInstance) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstance {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.CACertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *DBInstance {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceArn sets the DBInstanceArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceStatus sets the DBInstanceStatus field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceStatus(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceStatus = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBName(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroups sets the DBParameterGroups field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBParameterGroups(v []*DBParameterGroupStatus) *DBInstance {
s.DBParameterGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*DBSecurityGroupMembership) *DBInstance {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *DBInstance {
s.DBSubnetGroup = v
return s
}
// SetDbInstancePort sets the DbInstancePort field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDbInstancePort(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.DbInstancePort = &v
return s
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainMemberships sets the DomainMemberships field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDomainMemberships(v []*DomainMembership) *DBInstance {
s.DomainMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *DBInstance {
s.EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEndpoint(v *Endpoint) *DBInstance {
s.Endpoint = v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEngine(v string) *DBInstance {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBInstance {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn sets the EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBInstance {
s.InstanceCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetIops(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBInstance {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLatestRestorableTime sets the LatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetLatestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBInstance {
s.LatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBInstance {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBInstance {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupMemberships sets the OptionGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetOptionGroupMemberships(v []*OptionGroupMembership) *DBInstance {
s.OptionGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetPendingModifiedValues sets the PendingModifiedValues field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPendingModifiedValues(v *PendingModifiedValues) *DBInstance {
s.PendingModifiedValues = v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled sets the PerformanceInsightsEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.PerformanceInsightsEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *DBInstance {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *DBInstance {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *DBInstance {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBInstance {
s.ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers = v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBInstance {
s.ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers = v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone sets the SecondaryAvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstance {
s.SecondaryAvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetStatusInfos sets the StatusInfos field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetStatusInfos(v []*DBInstanceStatusInfo) *DBInstance {
s.StatusInfos = v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetStorageType(v string) *DBInstance {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetTimezone(v string) *DBInstance {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *DBInstance {
s.VpcSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// Provides a list of status information for a DB instance.
type DBInstanceStatusInfo struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Details of the error if there is an error for the instance. If the instance
// is not in an error state, this value is blank.
Message *string `type:"string"`
// Boolean value that is true if the instance is operating normally, or false
// if the instance is in an error state.
Normal *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Status of the DB instance. For a StatusType of read replica, the values can
// be replicating, error, stopped, or terminated.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// This value is currently "read replication."
StatusType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceStatusInfo) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceStatusInfo) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMessage sets the Message field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetMessage(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.Message = &v
return s
}
// SetNormal sets the Normal field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetNormal(v bool) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.Normal = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatus(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStatusType sets the StatusType field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatusType(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.StatusType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
type DBParameterGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB parameter group.
DBParameterGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group family that this DB parameter
// group is compatible with.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the customer-specified description for this DB parameter group.
Description *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupArn sets the DBParameterGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupArn(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDescription(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the ModifyDBParameterGroup
// or ResetDBParameterGroup action.
type DBParameterGroupNameMessage struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupNameMessage) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroupNameMessage {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// The status of the DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * CreateDBInstance
//
// * CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
//
// * DeleteDBInstance
//
// * ModifyDBInstance
//
// * RebootDBInstance
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
type DBParameterGroupStatus struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DP parameter group.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of parameter updates.
ParameterApplyStatus *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupStatus) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupStatus) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroupStatus) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroupStatus {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameterApplyStatus sets the ParameterApplyStatus field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroupStatus) SetParameterApplyStatus(v string) *DBParameterGroupStatus {
s.ParameterApplyStatus = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
type DBSecurityGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the description of the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a list of EC2SecurityGroup elements.
EC2SecurityGroups []*EC2SecurityGroup `locationNameList:"EC2SecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// Contains a list of IPRange elements.
IPRanges []*IPRange `locationNameList:"IPRange" type:"list"`
// Provides the AWS ID of the owner of a specific DB security group.
OwnerId *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the VpcId of the DB security group.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupArn sets the DBSecurityGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupArn(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.DBSecurityGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupDescription sets the DBSecurityGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.DBSecurityGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroups sets the EC2SecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroups(v []*EC2SecurityGroup) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetIPRanges sets the IPRanges field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetIPRanges(v []*IPRange) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.IPRanges = v
return s
}
// SetOwnerId sets the OwnerId field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetOwnerId(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.OwnerId = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * ModifyDBInstance
//
// * RebootDBInstance
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
type DBSecurityGroupMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the DB security group.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroupMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DBSecurityGroupMembership {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *DBSecurityGroupMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
type DBSnapshot struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the name of the Availability Zone the DB instance was located in
// at the time of the DB snapshot.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the DB instance identifier of the DB instance this DB snapshot
// was created from.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB snapshot.
DBSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the identifier for the DB snapshot.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB snapshot is encrypted.
Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the name of the database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the version of the database engine.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated
// Time (UTC).
InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Specifies the Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value of the DB
// instance at the time of the snapshot.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If Encrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted DB snapshot.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// License model information for the restored DB instance.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the master username for the DB snapshot.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the option group name for the DB snapshot.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The percentage of the estimated data that has been transferred.
PercentProgress *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the port that the database engine was listening on at the time
// of the snapshot.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated Time
// (UTC).
SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Provides the type of the DB snapshot.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
// The DB snapshot Amazon Resource Name (ARN) that the DB snapshot was copied
// from. It only has value in case of cross-customer or cross-region copy.
SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS Region that the DB snapshot was created in or copied from.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of this DB snapshot.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the storage type associated with DB snapshot.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the DB snapshot. In most cases, the Timezone element is
// empty. Timezone content appears only for snapshots taken from Microsoft SQL
// Server DB instances that were created with a time zone specified.
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB snapshot.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshot) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshot) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotArn sets the DBSnapshotArn field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotArn(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DBSnapshotArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEncrypted(v bool) *DBSnapshot {
s.Encrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEngine(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBSnapshot {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBSnapshot {
s.InstanceCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetIops(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetPercentProgress(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.PercentProgress = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetPort(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBSnapshot {
s.SnapshotCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSourceRegion(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetStatus(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetStorageType(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetTimezone(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Contains the name and values of a manual DB snapshot attribute
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API.
type DBSnapshotAttribute struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the manual DB snapshot attribute.
//
// The attribute named restore refers to the list of AWS accounts that have
// permission to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information,
// see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.
AttributeName *string `type:"string"`
// The value or values for the manual DB snapshot attribute.
//
// If the AttributeName field is set to restore, then this element returns a
// list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the
// manual DB snapshot. If a value of all is in the list, then the manual DB
// snapshot is public and available for any AWS account to copy or restore.
AttributeValues []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttribute) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttribute) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName(v string) *DBSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*string) *DBSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeValues = v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
type DBSnapshotAttributesResult struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of attributes and values for the manual DB snapshot.
DBSnapshotAttributes []*DBSnapshotAttribute `locationNameList:"DBSnapshotAttribute" type:"list"`
// The identifier of the manual DB snapshot that the attributes apply to.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttributesResult) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshotAttributes sets the DBSnapshotAttributes field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotAttributes(v []*DBSnapshotAttribute) *DBSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBSnapshotAttributes = v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
type DBSubnetGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the description of the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the status of the DB subnet group.
SubnetGroupStatus *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a list of Subnet elements.
Subnets []*Subnet `locationNameList:"Subnet" type:"list"`
// Provides the VpcId of the DB subnet group.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSubnetGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSubnetGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupArn sets the DBSubnetGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupArn(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.DBSubnetGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.DBSubnetGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetGroupStatus sets the SubnetGroupStatus field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnetGroupStatus(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.SubnetGroupStatus = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnets sets the Subnets field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnets(v []*Subnet) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.Subnets = v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB cluster identifier for the DB cluster to be deleted. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB cluster snapshot identifier of the new DB cluster snapshot created
// when SkipFinalSnapshot is set to false.
//
// Specifying this parameter and also setting the SkipFinalShapshot parameter
// to true results in an error.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Determines whether a final DB cluster snapshot is created before the DB cluster
// is deleted. If true is specified, no DB cluster snapshot is created. If false
// is specified, a DB cluster snapshot is created before the DB cluster is deleted.
//
// You must specify a FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier parameter if SkipFinalSnapshot
// is false.
//
// Default: false
SkipFinalSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterInput {
s.FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSkipFinalSnapshot sets the SkipFinalSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteDBClusterInput {
s.SkipFinalSnapshot = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *DeleteDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be the name of an existing DB cluster parameter group.
//
// * You can't delete a default DB cluster parameter group.
//
// * Cannot be associated with any DB clusters.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot to delete.
//
// Constraints: Must be the name of an existing DB cluster snapshot in the available
// state.
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot(v *DBClusterSnapshot) *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshot = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance identifier for the DB instance to be deleted. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the name of an existing DB instance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DBSnapshotIdentifier of the new DBSnapshot created when SkipFinalSnapshot
// is set to false.
//
// Specifying this parameter and also setting the SkipFinalShapshot parameter
// to true results in an error.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// * Cannot be specified when deleting a Read Replica.
FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Determines whether a final DB snapshot is created before the DB instance
// is deleted. If true is specified, no DBSnapshot is created. If false is specified,
// a DB snapshot is created before the DB instance is deleted.
//
// Note that when a DB instance is in a failure state and has a status of 'failed',
// 'incompatible-restore', or 'incompatible-network', it can only be deleted
// when the SkipFinalSnapshot parameter is set to "true".
//
// Specify true when deleting a Read Replica.
//
// The FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier parameter must be specified if SkipFinalSnapshot
// is false.
//
// Default: false
SkipFinalSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSkipFinalSnapshot sets the SkipFinalSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.SkipFinalSnapshot = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *DeleteDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be the name of an existing DB parameter group
//
// * You can't delete a default DB parameter group
//
// * Cannot be associated with any DB instances
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB security group to delete.
//
// You can't delete the default DB security group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// * Must not be "Default"
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DBSnapshot identifier.
//
// Constraints: Must be the name of an existing DB snapshot in the available
// state.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the database subnet group to delete.
//
// You can't delete the default subnet group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
// default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
//
// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput"}
if s.DBSubnetGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteEventSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to delete.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteEventSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type DeleteOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the option group to be deleted.
//
// You can't delete default option groups.
//
// OptionGroupName is a required field
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteOptionGroupInput"}
if s.OptionGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DeleteOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DescribeAccountAttributesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Data returned by the DescribeAccountAttributes action.
type DescribeAccountAttributesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of AccountQuota objects. Within this list, each quota has a name,
// a count of usage toward the quota maximum, and a maximum value for the quota.
AccountQuotas []*AccountQuota `locationNameList:"AccountQuota" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAccountQuotas sets the AccountQuotas field's value.
func (s *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) SetAccountQuotas(v []*AccountQuota) *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput {
s.AccountQuotas = v
return s
}
type DescribeCertificatesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied certificate identifier. If this parameter is specified,
// information for only the identified certificate is returned. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match an existing CertificateIdentifier.
CertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeCertificates
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeCertificatesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCertificateIdentifier sets the CertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetCertificateIdentifier(v string) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.CertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Data returned by the DescribeCertificates action.
type DescribeCertificatesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of Certificate objects for the AWS account.
Certificates []*Certificate `locationNameList:"Certificate" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeCertificates
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCertificates sets the Certificates field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesOutput) SetCertificates(v []*Certificate) *DescribeCertificatesOutput {
s.Certificates = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeCertificatesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB cluster parameter group to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DB cluster parameter groups.
DBClusterParameterGroups []*DBClusterParameterGroup `locationNameList:"DBClusterParameterGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroups sets the DBClusterParameterGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroups(v []*DBClusterParameterGroup) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB cluster parameter group to return parameter details
// for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A value that indicates to return only parameters for a specific source. Parameter
// sources can be engine, service, or customer.
Source *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterParametersInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetSource(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.Source = &v
return s
}
// Provides details about a DB cluster parameter group including the parameters
// in the DB cluster parameter group.
type DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a list of parameters for the DB cluster parameter group.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier for the DB cluster snapshot to describe the attributes for.
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput"}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The ID of the DB cluster to retrieve the list of DB cluster snapshots for.
// This parameter can't be used in conjunction with the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
// parameter. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A specific DB cluster snapshot identifier to describe. This parameter can't
// be used in conjunction with the DBClusterIdentifier parameter. This value
// is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBClusterSnapshot.
//
// * If this identifier is for an automated snapshot, the SnapshotType parameter
// must also be specified.
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// True to include manual DB cluster snapshots that are public and can be copied
// or restored by any AWS account, and otherwise false. The default is false.
// The default is false.
//
// You can share a manual DB cluster snapshot as public by using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
IncludePublic *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to include shared manual DB cluster snapshots from other AWS accounts
// that this AWS account has been given permission to copy or restore, and otherwise
// false. The default is false.
//
// You can give an AWS account permission to restore a manual DB cluster snapshot
// from another AWS account by the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
IncludeShared *bool `type:"boolean"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The type of DB cluster snapshots to be returned. You can specify one of the
// following values:
//
// * automated - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been automatically
// taken by Amazon RDS for my AWS account.
//
// * manual - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been taken by my
// AWS account.
//
// * shared - Return all manual DB cluster snapshots that have been shared
// to my AWS account.
//
// * public - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been marked as public.
//
// If you don't specify a SnapshotType value, then both automated and manual
// DB cluster snapshots are returned. You can include shared DB cluster snapshots
// with these results by setting the IncludeShared parameter to true. You can
// include public DB cluster snapshots with these results by setting the IncludePublic
// parameter to true.
//
// The IncludeShared and IncludePublic parameters don't apply for SnapshotType
// values of manual or automated. The IncludePublic parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to shared. The IncludeShared parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to public.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetIncludePublic sets the IncludePublic field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic(v bool) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludePublic = &v
return s
}
// SetIncludeShared sets the IncludeShared field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared(v bool) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludeShared = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// Provides a list of DB cluster snapshots for the user as the result of a call
// to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots action.
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Provides a list of DB cluster snapshots for the user.
DBClusterSnapshots []*DBClusterSnapshot `locationNameList:"DBClusterSnapshot" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshots sets the DBClusterSnapshots field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshots(v []*DBClusterSnapshot) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshots = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClustersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied DB cluster identifier. If this parameter is specified,
// information from only the specific DB cluster is returned. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A filter that specifies one or more DB clusters to describe.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusters request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClustersInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBClusters
// action.
type DescribeDBClustersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains a list of DB clusters for the user.
DBClusters []*DBCluster `locationNameList:"DBCluster" type:"list"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBClusters request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusters sets the DBClusters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersOutput) SetDBClusters(v []*DBCluster) *DescribeDBClustersOutput {
s.DBClusters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClustersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB parameter group family to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match an existing DBParameterGroupFamily.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates that only the default version of the specified engine or engine
// and major version combination is returned.
DefaultOnly *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to return.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The database engine version to return.
//
// Example: 5.1.49
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// If this parameter is specified and the requested engine supports the CharacterSetName
// parameter for CreateDBInstance, the response includes a list of supported
// character sets for each engine version.
ListSupportedCharacterSets *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If this parameter is specified and the requested engine supports the TimeZone
// parameter for CreateDBInstance, the response includes a list of supported
// time zones for each engine version.
ListSupportedTimezones *bool `type:"boolean"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultOnly sets the DefaultOnly field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDefaultOnly(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.DefaultOnly = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetEngine(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetListSupportedCharacterSets sets the ListSupportedCharacterSets field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedCharacterSets(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.ListSupportedCharacterSets = &v
return s
}
// SetListSupportedTimezones sets the ListSupportedTimezones field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedTimezones(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.ListSupportedTimezones = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBEngineVersions
// action.
type DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBEngineVersion elements.
DBEngineVersions []*DBEngineVersion `locationNameList:"DBEngineVersion" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBEngineVersions sets the DBEngineVersions field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) SetDBEngineVersions(v []*DBEngineVersion) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput {
s.DBEngineVersions = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBInstancesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier. If this parameter is specified, information
// from only the specific DB instance is returned. This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A filter that specifies one or more DB instances to describe.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB instances associated with the DB clusters identified by these
// ARNs.
//
// * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and DB instance Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB instances identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBInstances request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBInstancesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBInstances
// action.
type DescribeDBInstancesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBInstance instances.
DBInstances []*DBInstance `locationNameList:"DBInstance" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstances sets the DBInstances field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesOutput) SetDBInstances(v []*DBInstance) *DescribeDBInstancesOutput {
s.DBInstances = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element to DescribeDBLogFiles.
type DescribeDBLogFilesDetails struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A POSIX timestamp when the last log entry was written.
LastWritten *int64 `type:"long"`
// The name of the log file for the specified DB instance.
LogFileName *string `type:"string"`
// The size, in bytes, of the log file for the specified DB instance.
Size *int64 `type:"long"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetLastWritten sets the LastWritten field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetLastWritten(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails {
s.LastWritten = &v
return s
}
// SetLogFileName sets the LogFileName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetLogFileName(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails {
s.LogFileName = &v
return s
}
// SetSize sets the Size field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetSize(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails {
s.Size = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBLogFilesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The customer-assigned name of the DB instance that contains the log files
// you want to list.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Filters the available log files for files written since the specified date,
// in POSIX timestamp format with milliseconds.
FileLastWritten *int64 `type:"long"`
// Filters the available log files for files larger than the specified size.
FileSize *int64 `type:"long"`
// Filters the available log files for log file names that contain the specified
// string.
FilenameContains *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The pagination token provided in the previous request. If this parameter
// is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBLogFilesInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFileLastWritten sets the FileLastWritten field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileLastWritten(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.FileLastWritten = &v
return s
}
// SetFileSize sets the FileSize field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileSize(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.FileSize = &v
return s
}
// SetFilenameContains sets the FilenameContains field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilenameContains(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.FilenameContains = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// The response from a call to DescribeDBLogFiles.
type DescribeDBLogFilesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB log files returned.
DescribeDBLogFiles []*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails `locationNameList:"DescribeDBLogFilesDetails" type:"list"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBLogFiles request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDescribeDBLogFiles sets the DescribeDBLogFiles field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) SetDescribeDBLogFiles(v []*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput {
s.DescribeDBLogFiles = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB parameter group to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBParameterGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
type DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBParameterGroup instances.
DBParameterGroups []*DBParameterGroup `locationNameList:"DBParameterGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroups sets the DBParameterGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) SetDBParameterGroups(v []*DBParameterGroup) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput {
s.DBParameterGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB parameter group to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The parameter types to return.
//
// Default: All parameter types returned
//
// Valid Values: user | system | engine-default
Source *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBParametersInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetSource(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.Source = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBParameters
// action.
type DescribeDBParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of Parameter values.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParametersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersOutput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *DescribeDBParametersOutput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB security group to return details for.
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSecurityGroup instances.
DBSecurityGroups []*DBSecurityGroup `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*DBSecurityGroup) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot to describe the attributes for.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput"}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
DBSnapshotAttributesResult *DBSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput {
s.DBSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSnapshotsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The ID of the DB instance to retrieve the list of DB snapshots for. This
// parameter can't be used in conjunction with DBSnapshotIdentifier. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A specific DB snapshot identifier to describe. This parameter can't be used
// in conjunction with DBInstanceIdentifier. This value is stored as a lowercase
// string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBSnapshot.
//
// * If this identifier is for an automated snapshot, the SnapshotType parameter
// must also be specified.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// True to include manual DB snapshots that are public and can be copied or
// restored by any AWS account, and otherwise false. The default is false.
//
// You can share a manual DB snapshot as public by using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API.
IncludePublic *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to include shared manual DB snapshots from other AWS accounts that this
// AWS account has been given permission to copy or restore, and otherwise false.
// The default is false.
//
// You can give an AWS account permission to restore a manual DB snapshot from
// another AWS account by using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.
IncludeShared *bool `type:"boolean"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSnapshots request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The type of snapshots to be returned. You can specify one of the following
// values:
//
// * automated - Return all DB snapshots that have been automatically taken
// by Amazon RDS for my AWS account.
//
// * manual - Return all DB snapshots that have been taken by my AWS account.
//
// * shared - Return all manual DB snapshots that have been shared to my
// AWS account.
//
// * public - Return all DB snapshots that have been marked as public.
//
// If you don't specify a SnapshotType value, then both automated and manual
// snapshots are returned. Shared and public DB snapshots are not included in
// the returned results by default. You can include shared snapshots with these
// results by setting the IncludeShared parameter to true. You can include public
// snapshots with these results by setting the IncludePublic parameter to true.
//
// The IncludeShared and IncludePublic parameters don't apply for SnapshotType
// values of manual or automated. The IncludePublic parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to shared. The IncludeShared parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to public.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSnapshotsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetIncludePublic sets the IncludePublic field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic(v bool) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludePublic = &v
return s
}
// SetIncludeShared sets the IncludeShared field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared(v bool) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludeShared = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSnapshots
// action.
type DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSnapshot instances.
DBSnapshots []*DBSnapshot `locationNameList:"DBSnapshot" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshots sets the DBSnapshots field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) SetDBSnapshots(v []*DBSnapshot) *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput {
s.DBSnapshots = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB subnet group to return details for.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSubnetGroup instances.
DBSubnetGroups []*DBSubnetGroup `locationNameList:"DBSubnetGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroups sets the DBSubnetGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) SetDBSubnetGroups(v []*DBSubnetGroup) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput {
s.DBSubnetGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group family to return engine parameter
// information for.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// action.
EngineDefaults *EngineDefaults `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEngineDefaults sets the EngineDefaults field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) SetEngineDefaults(v *EngineDefaults) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput {
s.EngineDefaults = v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group family.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// action.
EngineDefaults *EngineDefaults `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEngineDefaults sets the EngineDefaults field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) SetEngineDefaults(v *EngineDefaults) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput {
s.EngineDefaults = v
return s
}
type DescribeEventCategoriesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The type of source that is generating the events.
//
// Valid values: db-instance | db-parameter-group | db-security-group | db-snapshot
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEventCategoriesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventCategoriesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventCategoriesInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// Data returned from the DescribeEventCategories action.
type DescribeEventCategoriesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EventCategoriesMap data types.
EventCategoriesMapList []*EventCategoriesMap `locationNameList:"EventCategoriesMap" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventCategoriesMapList sets the EventCategoriesMapList field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) SetEventCategoriesMapList(v []*EventCategoriesMap) *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput {
s.EventCategoriesMapList = v
return s
}
type DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to describe.
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
// Data returned by the DescribeEventSubscriptions action.
type DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EventSubscriptions data types.
EventSubscriptionsList []*EventSubscription `locationNameList:"EventSubscription" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscriptionsList sets the EventSubscriptionsList field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetEventSubscriptionsList(v []*EventSubscription) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput {
s.EventSubscriptionsList = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEventsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The number of minutes to retrieve events for.
//
// Default: 60
Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The end of the time interval for which to retrieve events, specified in ISO
// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia
// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
//
// Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z
EndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// A list of event categories that trigger notifications for a event notification
// subscription.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEvents request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The identifier of the event source for which events are returned. If not
// specified, then all sources are included in the response.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If SourceIdentifier is supplied, SourceType must also be provided.
//
// * If the source type is DBInstance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must be
// supplied.
//
// * If the source type is DBSecurityGroup, a DBSecurityGroupName must be
// supplied.
//
// * If the source type is DBParameterGroup, a DBParameterGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is DBSnapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be supplied.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The event source to retrieve events for. If no value is specified, all events
// are returned.
SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"`
// The beginning of the time interval to retrieve events for, specified in ISO
// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia
// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
//
// Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z
StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEventsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetEndTime sets the EndTime field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetEndTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.EndTime = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.StartTime = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEvents action.
type DescribeEventsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of Event instances.
Events []*Event `locationNameList:"Event" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous Events request. If this
// parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker,
// up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetEvents(v []*Event) *DescribeEventsOutput {
s.Events = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A required parameter. Options available for the given engine name are described.
//
// EngineName is a required field
EngineName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// If specified, filters the results to include only options for the specified
// major engine version.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput"}
if s.EngineName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EngineName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetEngineName(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// List of available option group options.
OptionGroupOptions []*OptionGroupOption `locationNameList:"OptionGroupOption" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupOptions sets the OptionGroupOptions field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) SetOptionGroupOptions(v []*OptionGroupOption) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput {
s.OptionGroupOptions = v
return s
}
type DescribeOptionGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Filters the list of option groups to only include groups associated with
// a specific database engine.
EngineName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// Filters the list of option groups to only include groups associated with
// a specific database engine version. If specified, then EngineName must also
// be specified.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOptionGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The name of the option group to describe. Cannot be supplied together with
// EngineName or MajorEngineVersion.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOptionGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetEngineName(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// List of option groups.
type DescribeOptionGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// List of option groups.
OptionGroupsList []*OptionGroup `locationNameList:"OptionGroup" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupsList sets the OptionGroupsList field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) SetOptionGroupsList(v []*OptionGroup) *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput {
s.OptionGroupsList = v
return s
}
type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified DB instance class.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the engine to retrieve DB instance options for.
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The engine version filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The license model filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified license model.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The VPC filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available VPC
// or non-VPC offerings.
Vpc *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput"}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetEngine(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetVpc sets the Vpc field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetVpc(v bool) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Vpc = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// action.
type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous OrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// An OrderableDBInstanceOption structure containing information about orderable
// options for the DB instance.
OrderableDBInstanceOptions []*OrderableDBInstanceOption `locationNameList:"OrderableDBInstanceOption" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetOrderableDBInstanceOptions sets the OrderableDBInstanceOptions field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) SetOrderableDBInstanceOptions(v []*OrderableDBInstanceOption) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput {
s.OrderableDBInstanceOptions = v
return s
}
type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A filter that specifies one or more resources to return pending maintenance
// actions for.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include pending maintenance
// actions for the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
//
// * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and DB instance ARNs.
// The results list will only include pending maintenance actions for the
// DB instances identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to a number of records specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN of a resource to return pending maintenance actions for.
ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetResourceIdentifier(v string) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.ResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// Data returned from the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions action.
type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to a number of records specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of the pending maintenance actions for the resource.
PendingMaintenanceActions []*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions `locationNameList:"ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetPendingMaintenanceActions sets the PendingMaintenanceActions field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) SetPendingMaintenanceActions(v []*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput {
s.PendingMaintenanceActions = v
return s
}
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only those
// reservations matching the specified DB instances class.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The duration filter value, specified in years or seconds. Specify this parameter
// to show only reservations for this duration.
//
// Valid Values: 1 | 3 | 31536000 | 94608000
Duration *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The Multi-AZ filter value. Specify this parameter to show only those reservations
// matching the specified Multi-AZ parameter.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified offering type.
//
// Valid Values: "Partial Upfront" | "All Upfront" | "No Upfront"
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// The product description filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
// those reservations matching the specified product description.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The reserved DB instance identifier filter value. Specify this parameter
// to show only the reservation that matches the specified reservation ID.
ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`
// The offering identifier filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
// purchased reservations matching the specified offering identifier.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetDuration(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetProductDescription(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.ReservedDBInstanceId = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified DB instance class.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Duration filter value, specified in years or seconds. Specify this parameter
// to show only reservations for this duration.
//
// Valid Values: 1 | 3 | 31536000 | 94608000
Duration *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The Multi-AZ filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified Multi-AZ parameter.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified offering type.
//
// Valid Values: "Partial Upfront" | "All Upfront" | "No Upfront"
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// Product description filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified product description.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The offering identifier filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
// the available offering that matches the specified reservation identifier.
//
// Example: 438012d3-4052-4cc7-b2e3-8d3372e0e706
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetDuration(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetProductDescription(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
// action.
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of reserved DB instance offerings.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferings []*ReservedDBInstancesOffering `locationNameList:"ReservedDBInstancesOffering" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferings sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferings field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferings(v []*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferings = v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// action.
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of reserved DB instances.
ReservedDBInstances []*ReservedDBInstance `locationNameList:"ReservedDBInstance" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstances sets the ReservedDBInstances field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) SetReservedDBInstances(v []*ReservedDBInstance) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput {
s.ReservedDBInstances = v
return s
}
type DescribeSourceRegionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeSourceRegions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The source AWS Region name. For example, us-east-1.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid AWS Region name.
RegionName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeSourceRegionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetRegionName sets the RegionName field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetRegionName(v string) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.RegionName = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeSourceRegions
// action.
type DescribeSourceRegionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of SourceRegion instances that contains each source AWS Region that
// the current AWS Region can get a Read Replica or a DB snapshot from.
SourceRegions []*SourceRegion `locationNameList:"SourceRegion" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegions sets the SourceRegions field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) SetSourceRegions(v []*SourceRegion) *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput {
s.SourceRegions = v
return s
}
type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The customer identifier or the ARN of your DB instance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// action. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.
ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage sets the ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage field's value.
func (s *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) SetValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage(v *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput {
s.ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage = v
return s
}
// An Active Directory Domain membership record associated with the DB instance.
type DomainMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the Active Directory Domain.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// The fully qualified domain name of the Active Directory Domain.
FQDN *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the Directory
// Service.
IAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the DB instance's Active Directory Domain membership, such
// as joined, pending-join, failed etc).
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DomainMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DomainMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetDomain(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetFQDN sets the FQDN field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetFQDN(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.FQDN = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMRoleName sets the IAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetIAMRoleName(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.IAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetStatus(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// A range of double values.
type DoubleRange struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The minimum value in the range.
From *float64 `type:"double"`
// The maximum value in the range.
To *float64 `type:"double"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DoubleRange) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DoubleRange) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetFrom sets the From field's value.
func (s *DoubleRange) SetFrom(v float64) *DoubleRange {
s.From = &v
return s
}
// SetTo sets the To field's value.
func (s *DoubleRange) SetTo(v float64) *DoubleRange {
s.To = &v
return s
}
type DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The customer-assigned name of the DB instance that contains the log files
// you want to list.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the log file to be downloaded.
//
// LogFileName is a required field
LogFileName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The pagination token provided in the previous request or "0". If the Marker
// parameter is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker
// until the end of the file or up to NumberOfLines.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The number of lines to download. If the number of lines specified results
// in a file over 1 MB in size, the file is truncated at 1 MB in size.
//
// If the NumberOfLines parameter is specified, then the block of lines returned
// can be from the beginning or the end of the log file, depending on the value
// of the Marker parameter.
//
// * If neither Marker or NumberOfLines are specified, the entire log file
// is returned up to a maximum of 10000 lines, starting with the most recent
// log entries first.
//
// * If NumberOfLines is specified and Marker is not specified, then the
// most recent lines from the end of the log file are returned.
//
// * If Marker is specified as "0", then the specified number of lines from
// the beginning of the log file are returned.
//
// * You can download the log file in blocks of lines by specifying the size
// of the block using the NumberOfLines parameter, and by specifying a value
// of "0" for the Marker parameter in your first request. Include the Marker
// value returned in the response as the Marker value for the next request,
// continuing until the AdditionalDataPending response element returns false.
NumberOfLines *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.LogFileName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LogFileName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetLogFileName sets the LogFileName field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetLogFileName(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.LogFileName = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetMarker(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetNumberOfLines sets the NumberOfLines field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetNumberOfLines(v int64) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.NumberOfLines = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element to DownloadDBLogFilePortion.
type DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Boolean value that if true, indicates there is more data to be downloaded.
AdditionalDataPending *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Entries from the specified log file.
LogFileData *string `type:"string"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DownloadDBLogFilePortion
// request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAdditionalDataPending sets the AdditionalDataPending field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetAdditionalDataPending(v bool) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput {
s.AdditionalDataPending = &v
return s
}
// SetLogFileData sets the LogFileData field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetLogFileData(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput {
s.LogFileData = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
//
// * DescribeDBSecurityGroups
//
// * RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
type EC2SecurityGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the id of the EC2 security group.
EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the EC2 security group.
EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the AWS ID of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in
// the EC2SecurityGroupName field.
EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the status of the EC2 security group. Status can be "authorizing",
// "authorized", "revoking", and "revoked".
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EC2SecurityGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EC2SecurityGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetStatus(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * CreateDBInstance
//
// * DescribeDBInstances
//
// * DeleteDBInstance
type Endpoint struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the DNS address of the DB instance.
Address *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the ID that Amazon Route 53 assigns when you create a hosted zone.
HostedZoneId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the port that the database engine is listening on.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Endpoint) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Endpoint) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAddress sets the Address field's value.
func (s *Endpoint) SetAddress(v string) *Endpoint {
s.Address = &v
return s
}
// SetHostedZoneId sets the HostedZoneId field's value.
func (s *Endpoint) SetHostedZoneId(v string) *Endpoint {
s.HostedZoneId = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *Endpoint) SetPort(v int64) *Endpoint {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// action.
type EngineDefaults struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the name of the DB parameter group family that the engine default
// parameters apply to.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous EngineDefaults request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a list of engine default parameters.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EngineDefaults) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EngineDefaults) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *EngineDefaults) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *EngineDefaults {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *EngineDefaults) SetMarker(v string) *EngineDefaults {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *EngineDefaults) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *EngineDefaults {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeEvents action.
type Event struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the date and time of the event.
Date *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Specifies the category for the event.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// Provides the text of this event.
Message *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the event.
SourceArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the identifier for the source of the event.
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the source type for this event.
SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Event) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Event) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDate sets the Date field's value.
func (s *Event) SetDate(v time.Time) *Event {
s.Date = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *Event) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *Event {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetMessage sets the Message field's value.
func (s *Event) SetMessage(v string) *Event {
s.Message = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceArn sets the SourceArn field's value.
func (s *Event) SetSourceArn(v string) *Event {
s.SourceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *Event) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *Event {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *Event) SetSourceType(v string) *Event {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
type EventCategoriesMap struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The event categories for the specified source type
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The source type that the returned categories belong to
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EventCategoriesMap) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EventCategoriesMap) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *EventCategoriesMap {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetSourceType(v string) *EventCategoriesMap {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
type EventSubscription struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The RDS event notification subscription Id.
CustSubscriptionId *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS customer account associated with the RDS event notification subscription.
CustomerAwsId *string `type:"string"`
// A Boolean value indicating if the subscription is enabled. True indicates
// the subscription is enabled.
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of event categories for the RDS event notification subscription.
EventCategoriesList []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the event subscription.
EventSubscriptionArn *string `type:"string"`
// The topic ARN of the RDS event notification subscription.
SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"`
// A list of source IDs for the RDS event notification subscription.
SourceIdsList []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"`
// The source type for the RDS event notification subscription.
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Constraints:
//
// Can be one of the following: creating | modifying | deleting | active | no-permission
// | topic-not-exist
//
// The status "no-permission" indicates that RDS no longer has permission to
// post to the SNS topic. The status "topic-not-exist" indicates that the topic
// was deleted after the subscription was created.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// The time the RDS event notification subscription was created.
SubscriptionCreationTime *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EventSubscription) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EventSubscription) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCustSubscriptionId sets the CustSubscriptionId field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustSubscriptionId(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.CustSubscriptionId = &v
return s
}
// SetCustomerAwsId sets the CustomerAwsId field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustomerAwsId(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.CustomerAwsId = &v
return s
}
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetEnabled(v bool) *EventSubscription {
s.Enabled = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategoriesList sets the EventCategoriesList field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventCategoriesList(v []*string) *EventSubscription {
s.EventCategoriesList = v
return s
}
// SetEventSubscriptionArn sets the EventSubscriptionArn field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventSubscriptionArn(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.EventSubscriptionArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.SnsTopicArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIdsList sets the SourceIdsList field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceIdsList(v []*string) *EventSubscription {
s.SourceIdsList = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceType(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetStatus(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionCreationTime sets the SubscriptionCreationTime field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSubscriptionCreationTime(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.SubscriptionCreationTime = &v
return s
}
type FailoverDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A DB cluster identifier to force a failover for. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the instance to promote to the primary instance.
//
// You must specify the instance identifier for an Aurora Replica in the DB
// cluster. For example, mydbcluster-replica1.
TargetDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *FailoverDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the TargetDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *FailoverDBClusterInput {
s.TargetDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type FailoverDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *FailoverDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
// This type is not currently supported.
type Filter struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
//
// Name is a required field
Name *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
//
// Values is a required field
Values []*string `locationNameList:"Value" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Filter) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Filter) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *Filter) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Filter"}
if s.Name == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
}
if s.Values == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Values"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *Filter) SetName(v string) *Filter {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetValues sets the Values field's value.
func (s *Filter) SetValues(v []*string) *Filter {
s.Values = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
type IPRange struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the IP range.
CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of the IP range. Status can be "authorizing", "authorized",
// "revoking", and "revoked".
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s IPRange) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s IPRange) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.
func (s *IPRange) SetCIDRIP(v string) *IPRange {
s.CIDRIP = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *IPRange) SetStatus(v string) *IPRange {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type ListTagsForResourceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The Amazon RDS resource with tags to be listed. This value is an Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing an RDS
// Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// ResourceName is a required field
ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListTagsForResourceInput"}
if s.ResourceName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *ListTagsForResourceInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *ListTagsForResourceInput {
s.ResourceName = &v
return s
}
type ListTagsForResourceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// List of tags returned by the ListTagsForResource operation.
TagList []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetTagList sets the TagList field's value.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceOutput) SetTagList(v []*Tag) *ListTagsForResourceOutput {
s.TagList = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A value that specifies whether the modifications in this request and any
// pending modifications are asynchronously applied as soon as possible, regardless
// of the PreferredMaintenanceWindow setting for the DB cluster. If this parameter
// is set to false, changes to the DB cluster are applied during the next maintenance
// window.
//
// The ApplyImmediately parameter only affects the NewDBClusterIdentifier and
// MasterUserPassword values. If you set the ApplyImmediately parameter value
// to false, then changes to the NewDBClusterIdentifier and MasterUserPassword
// values are applied during the next maintenance window. All other changes
// are applied immediately, regardless of the value of the ApplyImmediately
// parameter.
//
// Default: false
ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. You must specify
// a minimum value of 1.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 1 to 35
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The DB cluster identifier for the cluster being modified. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to use for the DB cluster.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The new password for the master database user. This password can contain
// any printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The new DB cluster identifier for the DB cluster when renaming a DB cluster.
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * The first character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-cluster2
NewDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
// specified option group. Changing this parameter does not result in an outage
// except in the following case, and the change is applied during the next maintenance
// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
// If the parameter change results in an option group that enables OEM, this
// change can cause a brief (sub-second) period during which new connections
// are rejected but existing connections are not interrupted.
//
// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. The option group
// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the DB cluster accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
// the time blocks available, see Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// A list of VPC security groups that the DB cluster will belong to.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.ApplyImmediately = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetNewDBClusterIdentifier sets the NewDBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetNewDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.NewDBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPort(v int64) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *ModifyDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to modify.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of parameters in the DB cluster parameter group to modify.
//
// Parameters is a required field
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Parameters == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Parameters"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster snapshot attribute to modify.
//
// To manage authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// DB cluster snapshot, set this value to restore.
//
// AttributeName is a required field
AttributeName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the DB cluster snapshot to modify the attributes for.
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of DB cluster snapshot attributes to add to the attribute specified
// by AttributeName.
//
// To authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot,
// set this list to include one or more AWS account IDs, or all to make the
// manual DB cluster snapshot restorable by any AWS account. Do not add the
// all value for any manual DB cluster snapshots that contain private information
// that you don't want available to all AWS accounts.
ValuesToAdd []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
// A list of DB cluster snapshot attributes to remove from the attribute specified
// by AttributeName.
//
// To remove authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// DB cluster snapshot, set this list to include one or more AWS account identifiers,
// or all to remove authorization for any AWS account to copy or restore the
// DB cluster snapshot. If you specify all, an AWS account whose account ID
// is explicitly added to the restore attribute can still copy or restore a
// manual DB cluster snapshot.
ValuesToRemove []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput"}
if s.AttributeName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AttributeName"))
}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetAttributeName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetValuesToAdd sets the ValuesToAdd field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToAdd(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToAdd = v
return s
}
// SetValuesToRemove sets the ValuesToRemove field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToRemove = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The new amount of storage (in gibibytes) to allocate for the DB instance.
//
// For MariaDB, MySQL, Oracle, and PostgreSQL, the value supplied must be at
// least 10% greater than the current value. Values that are not at least 10%
// greater than the existing value are rounded up so that they are 10% greater
// than the current value.
//
// For the valid values for allocated storage for each engine, see CreateDBInstance.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates that major version upgrades are allowed. Changing this parameter
// does not result in an outage and the change is asynchronously applied as
// soon as possible.
//
// Constraints: This parameter must be set to true when specifying a value for
// the EngineVersion parameter that is a different major version than the DB
// instance's current version.
AllowMajorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether the modifications in this request and any pending modifications
// are asynchronously applied as soon as possible, regardless of the PreferredMaintenanceWindow
// setting for the DB instance.
//
// If this parameter is set to false, changes to the DB instance are applied
// during the next maintenance window. Some parameter changes can cause an outage
// and are applied on the next call to RebootDBInstance, or the next failure
// reboot. Review the table of parameters in Modifying a DB Instance and Using
// the Apply Immediately Parameter (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.DBInstance.Modifying.html)
// to see the impact that setting ApplyImmediately to true or false has for
// each modified parameter and to determine when the changes are applied.
//
// Default: false
ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window. Changing this parameter does not
// result in an outage except in the following case and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible. An outage will result if this parameter is set
// to true during the maintenance window, and a newer minor version is available,
// and RDS has enabled auto patching for that engine version.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The number of days to retain automated backups. Setting this parameter to
// a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to 0 disables automated
// backups.
//
// Changing this parameter can result in an outage if you change from 0 to a
// non-zero value or from a non-zero value to 0. These changes are applied during
// the next maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set
// to true for this request. If you change the parameter from one non-zero value
// to another non-zero value, the change is asynchronously applied as soon as
// possible.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The retention period for automated backups is managed by
// the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 0 to 35
//
// * Can be specified for a MySQL Read Replica only if the source is running
// MySQL 5.6
//
// * Can be specified for a PostgreSQL Read Replica only if the source is
// running PostgreSQL 9.3.5
//
// * Cannot be set to 0 if the DB instance is a source to Read Replicas
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates the certificate that needs to be associated with the instance.
CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch
// Logs for a specific DB instance or DB cluster.
CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The new compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// If you modify the DB instance class, an outage occurs during the change.
// The change is applied during the next maintenance window, unless ApplyImmediately
// is specified as true for this request.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance identifier. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to apply to the DB instance. Changing
// this setting does not result in an outage. The parameter group name itself
// is changed immediately, but the actual parameter changes are not applied
// until you reboot the instance without failover. The db instance will NOT
// be rebooted automatically and the parameter changes will NOT be applied during
// the next maintenance window.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// Constraints: The DB parameter group must be in the same DB parameter group
// family as this DB instance.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// The value of the DBPortNumber parameter must not match any of the port values
// specified for options in the option group for the DB instance.
//
// Your database will restart when you change the DBPortNumber value regardless
// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// MySQL
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// MariaDB
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Default: 5432
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Oracle
//
// Default: 1521
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// SQL Server
//
// Default: 1433
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535 except for 1434, 3389, 47001, 49152, and 49152 through
// 49156.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
DBPortNumber *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A list of DB security groups to authorize on this DB instance. Changing this
// setting does not result in an outage and the change is asynchronously applied
// as soon as possible.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match existing DBSecurityGroups.
DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// The new DB subnet group for the DB instance. You can use this parameter to
// move your DB instance to a different VPC. If your DB instance is not in a
// VPC, you can also use this parameter to move your DB instance into a VPC.
// For more information, see Updating the VPC for a DB Instance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_VPC.WorkingWithRDSInstanceinaVPC.html#USER_VPC.Non-VPC2VPC).
//
// Changing the subnet group causes an outage during the change. The change
// is applied during the next maintenance window, unless you specify true for
// the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetGroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The Active Directory Domain to move the instance to. Specify none to remove
// the instance from its current domain. The domain must be created prior to
// this operation. Currently only a Microsoft SQL Server instance can be created
// in a Active Directory Domain.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the IAM role to use when making API calls to the Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Mapping AWS IAM accounts to database accounts is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// MySQL
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version number of the database engine to upgrade to. Changing this parameter
// results in an outage and the change is applied during the next maintenance
// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
//
// For major version upgrades, if a nondefault DB parameter group is currently
// in use, a new DB parameter group in the DB parameter group family for the
// new engine version must be specified. The new DB parameter group can be the
// default for that DB parameter group family.
//
// For a list of valid engine versions, see CreateDBInstance.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The new Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value for the RDS instance.
//
// Changing this setting does not result in an outage and the change is applied
// during the next maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter
// is set to true for this request. If you are migrating from Provisioned IOPS
// to standard storage, set this value to 0. The DB instance will require a
// reboot for the change in storage type to take effect.
//
// If you choose to migrate your DB instance from using standard storage to
// using Provisioned IOPS, or from using Provisioned IOPS to using standard
// storage, the process can take time. The duration of the migration depends
// on several factors such as database load, storage size, storage type (standard
// or Provisioned IOPS), amount of IOPS provisioned (if any), and the number
// of prior scale storage operations. Typical migration times are under 24 hours,
// but the process can take up to several days in some cases. During the migration,
// the DB instance is available for use, but might experience performance degradation.
// While the migration takes place, nightly backups for the instance are suspended.
// No other Amazon RDS operations can take place for the instance, including
// modifying the instance, rebooting the instance, deleting the instance, creating
// a Read Replica for the instance, and creating a DB snapshot of the instance.
//
// Constraints: For MariaDB, MySQL, Oracle, and PostgreSQL, the value supplied
// must be at least 10% greater than the current value. Values that are not
// at least 10% greater than the existing value are rounded up so that they
// are 10% greater than the current value.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The license model for the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The new password for the master user. The password can include any printable
// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Changing this parameter does not result in an outage and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible. Between the time of the request and the completion
// of the request, the MasterUserPassword element exists in the PendingModifiedValues
// element of the operation response.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The password for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 30 characters.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
//
// Amazon RDS API actions never return the password, so this action provides
// a way to regain access to a primary instance user if the password is lost.
// This includes restoring privileges that might have been accidentally revoked.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to To create an IAM role
// for Amazon RDS Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.IAMRole).
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. Changing this parameter
// does not result in an outage and the change is applied during the next maintenance
// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The new DB instance identifier for the DB instance when renaming a DB instance.
// When you change the DB instance identifier, an instance reboot will occur
// immediately if you set Apply Immediately to true, or will occur during the
// next maintenance window if Apply Immediately to false. This value is stored
// as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * The first character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
NewDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates that the DB instance should be associated with the specified option
// group. Changing this parameter does not result in an outage except in the
// following case and the change is applied during the next maintenance window
// unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request. If
// the parameter change results in an option group that enables OEM, this change
// can cause a brief (sub-second) period during which new connections are rejected
// but existing connections are not interrupted.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
// Changing this parameter does not result in an outage and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The daily time range for creating automated backups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi
//
// * Must be in Universal Time Coordinated (UTC)
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range (in UTC) during which system maintenance can occur,
// which might result in an outage. Changing this parameter does not result
// in an outage, except in the following situation, and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible. If there are pending actions that cause a reboot,
// and the maintenance window is changed to include the current time, then changing
// this parameter will cause a reboot of the DB instance. If moving this window
// to the current time, there must be at least 30 minutes between the current
// time and end of the window to ensure pending changes are applied.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// Valid Days: Mon | Tue | Wed | Thu | Fri | Sat | Sun
//
// Constraints: Must be at least 30 minutes
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
//
// Default: 1
//
// Valid Values: 0 - 15
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Boolean value that indicates if the DB instance has a publicly resolvable
// DNS name. Set to True to make the DB instance Internet-facing with a publicly
// resolvable DNS name, which resolves to a public IP address. Set to False
// to make the DB instance internal with a DNS name that resolves to a private
// IP address.
//
// PubliclyAccessible only applies to DB instances in a VPC. The DB instance
// must be part of a public subnet and PubliclyAccessible must be true in order
// for it to be publicly accessible.
//
// Changes to the PubliclyAccessible parameter are applied immediately regardless
// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// Default: false
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// If you specify Provisioned IOPS (io1), you must also include a value for
// the Iops parameter.
//
// If you choose to migrate your DB instance from using standard storage to
// using Provisioned IOPS, or from using Provisioned IOPS to using standard
// storage, the process can take time. The duration of the migration depends
// on several factors such as database load, storage size, storage type (standard
// or Provisioned IOPS), amount of IOPS provisioned (if any), and the number
// of prior scale storage operations. Typical migration times are under 24 hours,
// but the process can take up to several days in some cases. During the migration,
// the DB instance is available for use, but might experience performance degradation.
// While the migration takes place, nightly backups for the instance are suspended.
// No other Amazon RDS operations can take place for the instance, including
// modifying the instance, rebooting the instance, deleting the instance, creating
// a Read Replica for the instance, and creating a DB snapshot of the instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to authorize on this DB instance. This
// change is asynchronously applied as soon as possible.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The associated list of EC2 VPC security groups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match existing VpcSecurityGroupIds.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade sets the AllowMajorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.AllowMajorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.ApplyImmediately = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.CACertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration sets the CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration(v *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration = v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBPortNumber sets the DBPortNumber field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBPortNumber(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBPortNumber = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomain(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetIops(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier sets the NewDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.NewDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *ModifyDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// An array of parameter names, values, and the apply method for the parameter
// update. At least one parameter name, value, and apply method must be supplied;
// subsequent arguments are optional. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified
// in a single request.
//
// Valid Values (for the application method): immediate | pending-reboot
//
// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
// are applied when you reboot the DB instance without failover.
//
// Parameters is a required field
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Parameters == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Parameters"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB snapshot attribute to modify.
//
// To manage authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// DB snapshot, set this value to restore.
//
// AttributeName is a required field
AttributeName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot to modify the attributes for.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of DB snapshot attributes to add to the attribute specified by AttributeName.
//
// To authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual snapshot, set
// this list to include one or more AWS account IDs, or all to make the manual
// DB snapshot restorable by any AWS account. Do not add the all value for any
// manual DB snapshots that contain private information that you don't want
// available to all AWS accounts.
ValuesToAdd []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
// A list of DB snapshot attributes to remove from the attribute specified by
// AttributeName.
//
// To remove authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// snapshot, set this list to include one or more AWS account identifiers, or
// all to remove authorization for any AWS account to copy or restore the DB
// snapshot. If you specify all, an AWS account whose account ID is explicitly
// added to the restore attribute can still copy or restore the manual DB snapshot.
ValuesToRemove []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput"}
if s.AttributeName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AttributeName"))
}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetAttributeName(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetValuesToAdd sets the ValuesToAdd field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToAdd(v []*string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToAdd = v
return s
}
// SetValuesToRemove sets the ValuesToRemove field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToRemove = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
DBSnapshotAttributesResult *DBSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput {
s.DBSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB snapshot to modify.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The engine version to upgrade the DB snapshot to.
//
// The following are the database engines and engine versions that are available
// when you upgrade a DB snapshot.
//
// MySQL
//
// * 5.5.46 (supported for 5.1 DB snapshots)
//
// Oracle
//
// * 12.1.0.2.v8 (supported for 12.1.0.1 DB snapshots)
//
// * 11.2.0.4.v12 (supported for 11.2.0.2 DB snapshots)
//
// * 11.2.0.4.v11 (supported for 11.2.0.3 DB snapshots)
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The option group to identify with the upgraded DB snapshot.
//
// You can specify this parameter when you upgrade an Oracle DB snapshot. The
// same option group considerations apply when upgrading a DB snapshot as when
// upgrading a DB instance. For more information, see Option Group Considerations
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Oracle.html#USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Oracle.OGPG.OG).
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description for the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name for the DB subnet group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
// You can't modify the default subnet group.
//
// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
// default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
//
// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The EC2 subnet IDs for the DB subnet group.
//
// SubnetIds is a required field
SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput"}
if s.DBSubnetGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupName"))
}
if s.SubnetIds == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubnetIds"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.SubnetIds = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput {
s.DBSubnetGroup = v
return s
}
type ModifyEventSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A Boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription.
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of event categories for a SourceType that you want to subscribe to.
// You can see a list of the categories for a given SourceType in the Events
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic created for event notification.
// The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic and subscribe to
// it.
SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"`
// The type of source that is generating the events. For example, if you want
// to be notified of events generated by a DB instance, you would set this parameter
// to db-instance. if this value is not specified, all events are returned.
//
// Valid values: db-instance | db-parameter-group | db-security-group | db-snapshot
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyEventSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled(v bool) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.Enabled = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SnsTopicArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type ModifyOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates whether the changes should be applied immediately, or during the
// next maintenance window for each instance associated with the option group.
ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to be modified.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
//
// OptionGroupName is a required field
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Options in this list are added to the option group or, if already present,
// the specified configuration is used to update the existing configuration.
OptionsToInclude []*OptionConfiguration `locationNameList:"OptionConfiguration" type:"list"`
// Options in this list are removed from the option group.
OptionsToRemove []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyOptionGroupInput"}
if s.OptionGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupName"))
}
if s.OptionsToInclude != nil {
for i, v := range s.OptionsToInclude {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "OptionsToInclude", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.ApplyImmediately = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionsToInclude sets the OptionsToInclude field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToInclude(v []*OptionConfiguration) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionsToInclude = v
return s
}
// SetOptionsToRemove sets the OptionsToRemove field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionsToRemove = v
return s
}
type ModifyOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup(v *OptionGroup) *ModifyOptionGroupOutput {
s.OptionGroup = v
return s
}
// Option details.
type Option struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// If the option requires access to a port, then this DB security group allows
// access to the port.
DBSecurityGroupMemberships []*DBSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// The description of the option.
OptionDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option.
OptionName *string `type:"string"`
// The option settings for this option.
OptionSettings []*OptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionSetting" type:"list"`
// The version of the option.
OptionVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Indicate if this option is permanent.
Permanent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicate if this option is persistent.
Persistent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If required, the port configured for this option to use.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If the option requires access to a port, then this VPC security group allows
// access to the port.
VpcSecurityGroupMemberships []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Option) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Option) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships sets the DBSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *Option) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*DBSecurityGroupMembership) *Option {
s.DBSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetOptionDescription sets the OptionDescription field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionDescription(v string) *Option {
s.OptionDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionName sets the OptionName field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionName(v string) *Option {
s.OptionName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionSettings sets the OptionSettings field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionSettings(v []*OptionSetting) *Option {
s.OptionSettings = v
return s
}
// SetOptionVersion sets the OptionVersion field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionVersion(v string) *Option {
s.OptionVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetPermanent sets the Permanent field's value.
func (s *Option) SetPermanent(v bool) *Option {
s.Permanent = &v
return s
}
// SetPersistent sets the Persistent field's value.
func (s *Option) SetPersistent(v bool) *Option {
s.Persistent = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *Option) SetPort(v int64) *Option {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships sets the VpcSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *Option) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *Option {
s.VpcSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// A list of all available options
type OptionConfiguration struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSecurityGroupMemebrship name strings used for this option.
DBSecurityGroupMemberships []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// The configuration of options to include in a group.
//
// OptionName is a required field
OptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The option settings to include in an option group.
OptionSettings []*OptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionSetting" type:"list"`
// The version for the option.
OptionVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The optional port for the option.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A list of VpcSecurityGroupMemebrship name strings used for this option.
VpcSecurityGroupMemberships []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionConfiguration) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionConfiguration) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OptionConfiguration"}
if s.OptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships sets the DBSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.DBSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetOptionName sets the OptionName field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionName(v string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.OptionName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionSettings sets the OptionSettings field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionSettings(v []*OptionSetting) *OptionConfiguration {
s.OptionSettings = v
return s
}
// SetOptionVersion sets the OptionVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionVersion(v string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.OptionVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetPort(v int64) *OptionConfiguration {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships sets the VpcSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.VpcSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
type OptionGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates whether this option group can be applied to both VPC and non-VPC
// instances. The value true indicates the option group can be applied to both
// VPC and non-VPC instances.
AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates the name of the engine that this option group can be applied to.
EngineName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the major engine version associated with this option group.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the option group.
OptionGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a description of the option group.
OptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the option group.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates what options are available in the option group.
Options []*Option `locationNameList:"Option" type:"list"`
// If AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships is false, this field is blank. If
// AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships is true and this field is blank, then
// this option group can be applied to both VPC and non-VPC instances. If this
// field contains a value, then this option group can only be applied to instances
// that are in the VPC indicated by this field.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships sets the AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships(v bool) *OptionGroup {
s.AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetEngineName(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupArn sets the OptionGroupArn field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupArn(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.OptionGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupDescription sets the OptionGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.OptionGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptions sets the Options field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptions(v []*Option) *OptionGroup {
s.Options = v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Provides information on the option groups the DB instance is a member of.
type OptionGroupMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the option group that the instance belongs to.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the DB instance's option group membership. Valid values are:
// in-sync, pending-apply, pending-removal, pending-maintenance-apply, pending-maintenance-removal,
// applying, removing, and failed.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupMembership) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *OptionGroupMembership {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *OptionGroupMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Available option.
type OptionGroupOption struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// If the option requires a port, specifies the default port for the option.
DefaultPort *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The description of the option.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the engine that this option can be applied to.
EngineName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the major engine version that the option is available for.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The minimum required engine version for the option to be applied.
MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option.
Name *string `type:"string"`
// The option settings that are available (and the default value) for each option
// in an option group.
OptionGroupOptionSettings []*OptionGroupOptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionGroupOptionSetting" type:"list"`
// The versions that are available for the option.
OptionGroupOptionVersions []*OptionVersion `locationNameList:"OptionVersion" type:"list"`
// The options that conflict with this option.
OptionsConflictsWith []*string `locationNameList:"OptionConflictName" type:"list"`
// The options that are prerequisites for this option.
OptionsDependedOn []*string `locationNameList:"OptionName" type:"list"`
// Permanent options can never be removed from an option group. An option group
// containing a permanent option can't be removed from a DB instance.
Permanent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Persistent options can't be removed from an option group while DB instances
// are associated with the option group. If you disassociate all DB instances
// from the option group, your can remove the persistent option from the option
// group.
Persistent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether the option requires a port.
PortRequired *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If true, you must enable the Auto Minor Version Upgrade setting for your
// DB instance before you can use this option. You can enable Auto Minor Version
// Upgrade when you first create your DB instance, or by modifying your DB instance
// later.
RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If true, you can change the option to an earlier version of the option. This
// only applies to options that have different versions available.
SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If true, you can only use this option with a DB instance that is in a VPC.
VpcOnly *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOption) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOption) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDefaultPort sets the DefaultPort field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetDefaultPort(v int64) *OptionGroupOption {
s.DefaultPort = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetDescription(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetEngineName(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion sets the MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetName(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupOptionSettings sets the OptionGroupOptionSettings field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionSettings(v []*OptionGroupOptionSetting) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionGroupOptionSettings = v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupOptionVersions sets the OptionGroupOptionVersions field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionVersions(v []*OptionVersion) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionGroupOptionVersions = v
return s
}
// SetOptionsConflictsWith sets the OptionsConflictsWith field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsConflictsWith(v []*string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionsConflictsWith = v
return s
}
// SetOptionsDependedOn sets the OptionsDependedOn field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsDependedOn(v []*string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionsDependedOn = v
return s
}
// SetPermanent sets the Permanent field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPermanent(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Permanent = &v
return s
}
// SetPersistent sets the Persistent field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPersistent(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Persistent = &v
return s
}
// SetPortRequired sets the PortRequired field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPortRequired(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.PortRequired = &v
return s
}
// SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade sets the RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade sets the SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcOnly sets the VpcOnly field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetVpcOnly(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.VpcOnly = &v
return s
}
// Option group option settings are used to display settings available for each
// option with their default values and other information. These values are
// used with the DescribeOptionGroupOptions action.
type OptionGroupOptionSetting struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates the acceptable values for the option group option.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// The DB engine specific parameter type for the option group option.
ApplyType *string `type:"string"`
// The default value for the option group option.
DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`
// Boolean value where true indicates that this option group option can be changed
// from the default value.
IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The description of the option group option.
SettingDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option group option.
SettingName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOptionSetting) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOptionSetting) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetAllowedValues(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetApplyType(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.ApplyType = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetDefaultValue(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.DefaultValue = &v
return s
}
// SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.IsModifiable = &v
return s
}
// SetSettingDescription sets the SettingDescription field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingDescription(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.SettingDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetSettingName sets the SettingName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingName(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.SettingName = &v
return s
}
// Option settings are the actual settings being applied or configured for that
// option. It is used when you modify an option group or describe option groups.
// For example, the NATIVE_NETWORK_ENCRYPTION option has a setting called SQLNET.ENCRYPTION_SERVER
// that can have several different values.
type OptionSetting struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The allowed values of the option setting.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// The DB engine specific parameter type.
ApplyType *string `type:"string"`
// The data type of the option setting.
DataType *string `type:"string"`
// The default value of the option setting.
DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`
// The description of the option setting.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the option setting is part of a collection.
IsCollection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A Boolean value that, when true, indicates the option setting can be modified
// from the default.
IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option that has settings that you can set.
Name *string `type:"string"`
// The current value of the option setting.
Value *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionSetting) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionSetting) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetAllowedValues(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetApplyType(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.ApplyType = &v
return s
}
// SetDataType sets the DataType field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetDataType(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.DataType = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetDefaultValue(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.DefaultValue = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetDescription(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetIsCollection sets the IsCollection field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetIsCollection(v bool) *OptionSetting {
s.IsCollection = &v
return s
}
// SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *OptionSetting {
s.IsModifiable = &v
return s
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetName(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetValue(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.Value = &v
return s
}
// The version for an option. Option group option versions are returned by the
// DescribeOptionGroupOptions action.
type OptionVersion struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// True if the version is the default version of the option, and otherwise false.
IsDefault *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version of the option.
Version *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionVersion) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionVersion) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetIsDefault sets the IsDefault field's value.
func (s *OptionVersion) SetIsDefault(v bool) *OptionVersion {
s.IsDefault = &v
return s
}
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
func (s *OptionVersion) SetVersion(v string) *OptionVersion {
s.Version = &v
return s
}
// Contains a list of available options for a DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// action.
type OrderableDBInstanceOption struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of Availability Zones for a DB instance.
AvailabilityZones []*AvailabilityZone `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The DB instance class for a DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The engine type of a DB instance.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The engine version of a DB instance.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The license model for a DB instance.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Maximum total provisioned IOPS for a DB instance.
MaxIopsPerDbInstance *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Maximum provisioned IOPS per GiB for a DB instance.
MaxIopsPerGib *float64 `type:"double"`
// Maximum storage size for a DB instance.
MaxStorageSize *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Minimum total provisioned IOPS for a DB instance.
MinIopsPerDbInstance *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Minimum provisioned IOPS per GiB for a DB instance.
MinIopsPerGib *float64 `type:"double"`
// Minimum storage size for a DB instance.
MinStorageSize *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance is Multi-AZ capable.
MultiAZCapable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance can have a Read Replica.
ReadReplicaCapable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates the storage type for a DB instance.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports Enhanced Monitoring at intervals
// from 1 to 60 seconds.
SupportsEnhancedMonitoring *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports IAM database authentication.
SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports provisioned IOPS.
SupportsIops *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True if a DB instance supports Performance Insights, otherwise false.
SupportsPerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports encrypted storage.
SupportsStorageEncryption *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance is in a VPC.
Vpc *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OrderableDBInstanceOption) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OrderableDBInstanceOption) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*AvailabilityZone) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetEngine(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetEngineVersion(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetLicenseModel(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance sets the MaxIopsPerDbInstance field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MaxIopsPerDbInstance = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxIopsPerGib sets the MaxIopsPerGib field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerGib(v float64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MaxIopsPerGib = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxStorageSize sets the MaxStorageSize field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxStorageSize(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MaxStorageSize = &v
return s
}
// SetMinIopsPerDbInstance sets the MinIopsPerDbInstance field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerDbInstance(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MinIopsPerDbInstance = &v
return s
}
// SetMinIopsPerGib sets the MinIopsPerGib field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerGib(v float64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MinIopsPerGib = &v
return s
}
// SetMinStorageSize sets the MinStorageSize field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinStorageSize(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MinStorageSize = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZCapable sets the MultiAZCapable field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMultiAZCapable(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MultiAZCapable = &v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaCapable sets the ReadReplicaCapable field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetReadReplicaCapable(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.ReadReplicaCapable = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetStorageType(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring sets the SupportsEnhancedMonitoring field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsEnhancedMonitoring = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsIops sets the SupportsIops field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIops(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsIops = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsPerformanceInsights sets the SupportsPerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsPerformanceInsights(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsPerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsStorageEncryption sets the SupportsStorageEncryption field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsStorageEncryption(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsStorageEncryption = &v
return s
}
// SetVpc sets the Vpc field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetVpc(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.Vpc = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a request parameter in the ModifyDBParameterGroup
// and ResetDBParameterGroup actions.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// and DescribeDBParameters actions.
type Parameter struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the valid range of values for the parameter.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates when to apply parameter updates.
ApplyMethod *string `type:"string" enum:"ApplyMethod"`
// Specifies the engine specific parameters type.
ApplyType *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the valid data type for the parameter.
DataType *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a description of the parameter.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates whether (true) or not (false) the parameter can be modified. Some
// parameters have security or operational implications that prevent them from
// being changed.
IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The earliest engine version to which the parameter can apply.
MinimumEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the parameter.
ParameterName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the value of the parameter.
ParameterValue *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the source of the parameter value.
Source *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Parameter) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Parameter) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetAllowedValues(v string) *Parameter {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyMethod sets the ApplyMethod field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetApplyMethod(v string) *Parameter {
s.ApplyMethod = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetApplyType(v string) *Parameter {
s.ApplyType = &v
return s
}
// SetDataType sets the DataType field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetDataType(v string) *Parameter {
s.DataType = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetDescription(v string) *Parameter {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *Parameter {
s.IsModifiable = &v
return s
}
// SetMinimumEngineVersion sets the MinimumEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetMinimumEngineVersion(v string) *Parameter {
s.MinimumEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetParameterName sets the ParameterName field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetParameterName(v string) *Parameter {
s.ParameterName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameterValue sets the ParameterValue field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetParameterValue(v string) *Parameter {
s.ParameterValue = &v
return s
}
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetSource(v string) *Parameter {
s.Source = &v
return s
}
// A list of the log types whose configuration is still pending. In other words,
// these log types are in the process of being activated or deactivated.
type PendingCloudwatchLogsExports struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Log types that are in the process of being enabled. After they are enabled,
// these log types are exported to CloudWatch Logs.
LogTypesToDisable []*string `type:"list"`
// Log types that are in the process of being deactivated. After they are deactivated,
// these log types aren't exported to CloudWatch Logs.
LogTypesToEnable []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetLogTypesToDisable sets the LogTypesToDisable field's value.
func (s *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToDisable(v []*string) *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports {
s.LogTypesToDisable = v
return s
}
// SetLogTypesToEnable sets the LogTypesToEnable field's value.
func (s *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToEnable(v []*string) *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports {
s.LogTypesToEnable = v
return s
}
// Provides information about a pending maintenance action for a resource.
type PendingMaintenanceAction struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The type of pending maintenance action that is available for the resource.
Action *string `type:"string"`
// The date of the maintenance window when the action is applied. The maintenance
// action is applied to the resource during its first maintenance window after
// this date. If this date is specified, any next-maintenance opt-in requests
// are ignored.
AutoAppliedAfterDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// The effective date when the pending maintenance action is applied to the
// resource. This date takes into account opt-in requests received from the
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API, the AutoAppliedAfterDate, and the ForcedApplyDate.
// This value is blank if an opt-in request has not been received and nothing
// has been specified as AutoAppliedAfterDate or ForcedApplyDate.
CurrentApplyDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// A description providing more detail about the maintenance action.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// The date when the maintenance action is automatically applied. The maintenance
// action is applied to the resource on this date regardless of the maintenance
// window for the resource. If this date is specified, any immediate opt-in
// requests are ignored.
ForcedApplyDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// Indicates the type of opt-in request that has been received for the resource.
OptInStatus *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PendingMaintenanceAction) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PendingMaintenanceAction) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAction sets the Action field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAction(v string) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.Action = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoAppliedAfterDate sets the AutoAppliedAfterDate field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAutoAppliedAfterDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.AutoAppliedAfterDate = &v
return s
}
// SetCurrentApplyDate sets the CurrentApplyDate field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetCurrentApplyDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.CurrentApplyDate = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetDescription(v string) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetForcedApplyDate sets the ForcedApplyDate field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetForcedApplyDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.ForcedApplyDate = &v
return s
}
// SetOptInStatus sets the OptInStatus field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetOptInStatus(v string) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.OptInStatus = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the ModifyDBInstance action.
type PendingModifiedValues struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the new AllocatedStorage size for the DB instance that will be applied
// or is currently being applied.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the pending number of days for which automated backups are retained.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the identifier of the CA certificate for the DB instance.
CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the new DBInstanceClass for the DB instance that will be applied
// or is currently being applied.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the new DBInstanceIdentifier for the DB instance that will be applied
// or is currently being applied.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The new DB subnet group for the DB instance.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the new Provisioned IOPS value for the DB instance that will be
// applied or is currently being applied.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The license model for the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the pending or currently-in-progress change of the master credentials
// for the DB instance.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates that the Single-AZ DB instance is to change to a Multi-AZ deployment.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of the log types whose configuration is still pending. In other words,
// these log types are in the process of being activated or deactivated.
PendingCloudwatchLogsExports *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the pending port for the DB instance.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PendingModifiedValues) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PendingModifiedValues) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.CACertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetEngineVersion(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetIops(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetLicenseModel(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports sets the PendingCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports(v *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.PendingCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetPort(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetStorageType(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster Read Replica to promote. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster Read Replica.
//
// Example: my-cluster-replica1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The number of days to retain automated backups. Setting this parameter to
// a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to 0 disables automated
// backups.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 0 to 8
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The DB instance identifier. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing Read Replica DB instance.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PromoteReadReplicaInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PromoteReadReplicaInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *PromoteReadReplicaOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The number of instances to reserve.
//
// Default: 1
DBInstanceCount *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Customer-specified identifier to track this reservation.
//
// Example: myreservationID
ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`
// The ID of the Reserved DB instance offering to purchase.
//
// Example: 438012d3-4052-4cc7-b2e3-8d3372e0e706
//
// ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId is a required field
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput"}
if s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceCount sets the DBInstanceCount field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetDBInstanceCount(v int64) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.DBInstanceCount = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.ReservedDBInstanceId = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// and PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering actions.
ReservedDBInstance *ReservedDBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetReservedDBInstance sets the ReservedDBInstance field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) SetReservedDBInstance(v *ReservedDBInstance) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput {
s.ReservedDBInstance = v
return s
}
// A range of integer values.
type Range struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The minimum value in the range.
From *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The step value for the range. For example, if you have a range of 5,000 to
// 10,000, with a step value of 1,000, the valid values start at 5,000 and step
// up by 1,000. Even though 7,500 is within the range, it isn't a valid value
// for the range. The valid values are 5,000, 6,000, 7,000, 8,000...
Step *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The maximum value in the range.
To *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Range) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Range) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetFrom sets the From field's value.
func (s *Range) SetFrom(v int64) *Range {
s.From = &v
return s
}
// SetStep sets the Step field's value.
func (s *Range) SetStep(v int64) *Range {
s.Step = &v
return s
}
// SetTo sets the To field's value.
func (s *Range) SetTo(v int64) *Range {
s.To = &v
return s
}
type RebootDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// When true, the reboot is conducted through a MultiAZ failover.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify true if the instance is not configured for
// MultiAZ.
ForceFailover *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RebootDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RebootDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetForceFailover sets the ForceFailover field's value.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) SetForceFailover(v bool) *RebootDBInstanceInput {
s.ForceFailover = &v
return s
}
type RebootDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RebootDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// and DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings actions.
type RecurringCharge struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The amount of the recurring charge.
RecurringChargeAmount *float64 `type:"double"`
// The frequency of the recurring charge.
RecurringChargeFrequency *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RecurringCharge) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RecurringCharge) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetRecurringChargeAmount sets the RecurringChargeAmount field's value.
func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeAmount(v float64) *RecurringCharge {
s.RecurringChargeAmount = &v
return s
}
// SetRecurringChargeFrequency sets the RecurringChargeFrequency field's value.
func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeFrequency(v string) *RecurringCharge {
s.RecurringChargeFrequency = &v
return s
}
type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster to disassociate the IAM role from.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to disassociate from the Aurora
// DB cluster, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AuroraAccessRole.
//
// RoleArn is a required field
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.RoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The source identifier to be removed from the subscription, such as the DB
// instance identifier for a DB instance or the name of a security group.
//
// SourceIdentifier is a required field
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to remove a
// source identifier from.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SourceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceIdentifier"))
}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type RemoveTagsFromResourceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon RDS resource that the tags are removed from. This value is an
// Amazon Resource Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing
// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// ResourceName is a required field
ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tag key (name) of the tag to be removed.
//
// TagKeys is a required field
TagKeys []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveTagsFromResourceInput"}
if s.ResourceName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName"))
}
if s.TagKeys == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TagKeys"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.
func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput {
s.ResourceName = &v
return s
}
// SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value.
func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput {
s.TagKeys = v
return s
}
type RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// and PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering actions.
type ReservedDBInstance struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The currency code for the reserved DB instance.
CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance class for the reserved DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The number of reserved DB instances.
DBInstanceCount *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The duration of the reservation in seconds.
Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The fixed price charged for this reserved DB instance.
FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"`
// Indicates if the reservation applies to Multi-AZ deployments.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type of this reserved DB instance.
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// The description of the reserved DB instance.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The recurring price charged to run this reserved DB instance.
RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the reserved DB instance.
ReservedDBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`
// The unique identifier for the reservation.
ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`
// The offering identifier.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
// The time the reservation started.
StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// The state of the reserved DB instance.
State *string `type:"string"`
// The hourly price charged for this reserved DB instance.
UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstance) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstance) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.CurrencyCode = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceCount sets the DBInstanceCount field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceCount(v int64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.DBInstanceCount = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.FixedPrice = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetProductDescription(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.RecurringCharges = v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceArn sets the ReservedDBInstanceArn field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceArn(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ReservedDBInstanceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ReservedDBInstanceId = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.StartTime = &v
return s
}
// SetState sets the State field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetState(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.State = &v
return s
}
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.UsagePrice = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
// action.
type ReservedDBInstancesOffering struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The currency code for the reserved DB instance offering.
CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance class for the reserved DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The duration of the offering in seconds.
Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The fixed price charged for this offering.
FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"`
// Indicates if the offering applies to Multi-AZ deployments.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type.
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// The database engine used by the offering.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The recurring price charged to run this reserved DB instance.
RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"`
// The offering identifier.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
// The hourly price charged for this offering.
UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstancesOffering) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstancesOffering) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.CurrencyCode = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.FixedPrice = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetProductDescription(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.RecurringCharges = v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.UsagePrice = &v
return s
}
type ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to reset.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of parameter names in the DB cluster parameter group to reset to the
// default values. You can't use this parameter if the ResetAllParameters parameter
// is set to true.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
// A value that is set to true to reset all parameters in the DB cluster parameter
// group to their default values, and false otherwise. You can't use this parameter
// if there is a list of parameter names specified for the Parameters parameter.
ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
// SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters(v bool) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.ResetAllParameters = &v
return s
}
type ResetDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// To reset the entire DB parameter group, specify the DBParameterGroup name
// and ResetAllParameters parameters. To reset specific parameters, provide
// a list of the following: ParameterName and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters
// can be modified in a single request.
//
// MySQL
//
// Valid Values (for Apply method): immediate | pending-reboot
//
// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
// are applied when DB instance reboots.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Valid Values (for Apply method): immediate | pending-reboot
//
// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
// are applied when DB instance reboots.
//
// Oracle
//
// Valid Values (for Apply method): pending-reboot
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
// Specifies whether (true) or not (false) to reset all parameters in the DB
// parameter group to default values.
//
// Default: true
ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
// SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters(v bool) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput {
s.ResetAllParameters = &v
return s
}
// Describes the pending maintenance actions for a resource.
type ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list that provides details about the pending maintenance actions for the
// resource.
PendingMaintenanceActionDetails []*PendingMaintenanceAction `locationNameList:"PendingMaintenanceAction" type:"list"`
// The ARN of the resource that has pending maintenance actions.
ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetPendingMaintenanceActionDetails sets the PendingMaintenanceActionDetails field's value.
func (s *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) SetPendingMaintenanceActionDetails(v []*PendingMaintenanceAction) *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions {
s.PendingMaintenanceActionDetails = v
return s
}
// SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) SetResourceIdentifier(v string) *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions {
s.ResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the restored DB cluster
// can be created in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The number of days for which automated backups of the restored DB cluster
// are retained. You must specify a minimum value of 1.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 1 to 35
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A value that indicates that the restored DB cluster should be associated
// with the specified CharacterSet.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB cluster to create from the source data in the Amazon S3
// bucket. This parameter is isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with the restored
// DB cluster. If this argument is omitted, default.aurora5.6 is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with the restored DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The database name for the restored DB cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for the restored DB cluster.
//
// Valid Values: aurora, aurora-postgresql
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use.
//
// Aurora
//
// Example: 5.6.10a
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
//
// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master database user. This password can contain any
// printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// MasterUserPassword is a required field
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the master user for the restored DB cluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// MasterUsername is a required field
MasterUsername *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A value that indicates that the restored DB cluster should be associated
// with the specified option group.
//
// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. An option group
// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the instances in the restored DB cluster accept
// connections.
//
// Default: 3306
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
// the time blocks available, see Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the Amazon S3 bucket that contains the data used to create the
// Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// S3BucketName is a required field
S3BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the AWS Identity and Access Management
// (IAM) role that authorizes Amazon RDS to access the Amazon S3 bucket on your
// behalf.
//
// S3IngestionRoleArn is a required field
S3IngestionRoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The prefix for all of the file names that contain the data used to create
// the Amazon Aurora DB cluster. If you do not specify a SourceS3Prefix value,
// then the Amazon Aurora DB cluster is created by using all of the files in
// the Amazon S3 bucket.
S3Prefix *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the database engine that was backed up to create the files
// stored in the Amazon S3 bucket.
//
// Valid values: mysql
//
// SourceEngine is a required field
SourceEngine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version of the database that the backup files were created from.
//
// MySQL version 5.5 and 5.6 are supported.
//
// Example: 5.6.22
//
// SourceEngineVersion is a required field
SourceEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies whether the restored DB cluster is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with the restored DB cluster.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.MasterUserPassword == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MasterUserPassword"))
}
if s.MasterUsername == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MasterUsername"))
}
if s.S3BucketName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3BucketName"))
}
if s.S3IngestionRoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3IngestionRoleArn"))
}
if s.SourceEngine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngine"))
}
if s.SourceEngineVersion == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngineVersion"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDatabaseName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUsername(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetS3BucketName sets the S3BucketName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3BucketName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.S3BucketName = &v
return s
}
// SetS3IngestionRoleArn sets the S3IngestionRoleArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.S3IngestionRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetS3Prefix sets the S3Prefix field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3Prefix(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.S3Prefix = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngine sets the SourceEngine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngine(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngine = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngineVersion sets the SourceEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the restored
// DB cluster can be created in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The name of the DB cluster to create from the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
// This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-snapshot-id
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB subnet group to use for the new DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The database name for the restored DB cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to use for the new DB cluster.
//
// Default: The same as source
//
// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version of the database engine to use for the new DB cluster.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier to use when restoring an encrypted DB cluster
// from a DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are restoring a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
//
// If you do not specify a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, then the following
// will occur:
//
// * If the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot in SnapshotIdentifier is encrypted,
// then the restored DB cluster is encrypted using the KMS key that was used
// to encrypt the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * If the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot in SnapshotIdentifier is not
// encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is not encrypted.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option group to use for the restored DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the new DB cluster accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot to restore from.
//
// You can use either the name or the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) to specify
// a DB cluster snapshot. However, you can use only the ARN to specify a DB
// snapshot.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing Snapshot.
//
// SnapshotIdentifier is a required field
SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tags to be assigned to the restored DB cluster.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of VPC security groups that the new DB cluster will belong to.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the new DB cluster to be created.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB subnet group name to use for the new DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier to use when restoring an encrypted DB cluster
// from an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are restoring a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
//
// You can restore to a new DB cluster and encrypt the new DB cluster with a
// KMS key that is different than the KMS key used to encrypt the source DB
// cluster. The new DB cluster is encrypted with the KMS key identified by the
// KmsKeyId parameter.
//
// If you do not specify a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, then the following
// will occur:
//
// * If the DB cluster is encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is encrypted
// using the KMS key that was used to encrypt the source DB cluster.
//
// * If the DB cluster is not encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is
// not encrypted.
//
// If DBClusterIdentifier refers to a DB cluster that is not encrypted, then
// the restore request is rejected.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option group for the new DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the new DB cluster accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The date and time to restore the DB cluster to.
//
// Valid Values: Value must be a time in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) format
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be before the latest restorable time for the DB instance
//
// * Must be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is not provided
//
// * Cannot be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is true
//
// * Cannot be specified if RestoreType parameter is copy-on-write
//
// Example: 2015-03-07T23:45:00Z
RestoreToTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// The type of restore to be performed. You can specify one of the following
// values:
//
// * full-copy - The new DB cluster is restored as a full copy of the source
// DB cluster.
//
// * copy-on-write - The new DB cluster is restored as a clone of the source
// DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: You can't specify copy-on-write if the engine version of the
// source DB cluster is earlier than 1.11.
//
// If you don't specify a RestoreType value, then the new DB cluster is restored
// as a full copy of the source DB cluster.
RestoreType *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier of the source DB cluster from which to restore.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// SourceDBClusterIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A value that is set to true to restore the DB cluster to the latest restorable
// backup time, and false otherwise.
//
// Default: false
//
// Constraints: Cannot be specified if RestoreToTime parameter is provided.
UseLatestRestorableTime *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of VPC security groups that the new DB cluster belongs to.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.SourceDBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreToTime sets the RestoreToTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreToTime(v time.Time) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.RestoreToTime = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreType sets the RestoreType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreType(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.RestoreType = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.SourceDBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetUseLatestRestorableTime sets the UseLatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetUseLatestRestorableTime(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.UseLatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
//
// Example: us-east-1a
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the DB
// instance, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the Amazon RDS DB instance, for example,
// db.m4.large. Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions,
// or for all database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and
// availability for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: The same DBInstanceClass as the original DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Name of the DB instance to create from the DB snapshot. This parameter isn't
// case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 numbers, letters, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-snapshot-id
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The database name for the restored DB instance.
//
// This parameter doesn't apply to the MySQL, PostgreSQL, or MariaDB engines.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot to restore from.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBSnapshot.
//
// * If you are restoring from a shared manual DB snapshot, the DBSnapshotIdentifier
// must be the ARN of the shared DB snapshot.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB subnet group name to use for the new instance.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the Active Directory Domain to restore the instance in.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
// Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// * Aurora 5.6 or higher.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to use for the new instance.
//
// Default: The same as source
//
// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source. For example,
// you can restore a MariaDB 10.1 DB instance from a MySQL 5.6 snapshot.
//
// Valid Values:
//
// * aurora
//
// * aurora-postgresql
//
// * mariadb
//
// * mysql
//
// * oracle-ee
//
// * oracle-se2
//
// * oracle-se1
//
// * oracle-se
//
// * postgres
//
// * sqlserver-ee
//
// * sqlserver-se
//
// * sqlserver-ex
//
// * sqlserver-web
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the amount of provisioned IOPS for the DB instance, expressed in
// I/O operations per second. If this parameter is not specified, the IOPS value
// is taken from the backup. If this parameter is set to 0, the new instance
// is converted to a non-PIOPS instance. The conversion takes additional time,
// though your DB instance is available for connections before the conversion
// starts.
//
// The provisioned IOPS value must follow the requirements for your database
// engine. For more information, see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to
// Improve Performance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS).
//
// Constraints: Must be an integer greater than 1000.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// License model information for the restored DB instance.
//
// Default: Same as source.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to be used for the restored DB instance.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB instance
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
//
// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
//
// * Default VPC: true
//
// * VPC: false
//
// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDomain(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetIops(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetStorageType(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The amount of storage (in gigabytes) to allocate initially for the DB instance.
// Follow the allocation rules specified in CreateDBInstance.
//
// Be sure to allocate enough memory for your new DB instance so that the restore
// operation can succeed. You can also allocate additional memory for future
// growth.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// True to indicate that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to
// the DB instance during the maintenance window, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: true
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in. For information
// about AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
// Region.
//
// Example: us-east-1d
//
// Constraint: The AvailabilityZone parameter can't be specified if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true. The specified Availability Zone must be in the
// same AWS Region as the current endpoint.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. Setting this
// parameter to a positive number enables backups. For more information, see
// CreateDBInstance.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
// and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Importing from Amazon S3 is not supported on the db.t2.micro DB instance
// class.
//
// DBInstanceClass is a required field
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. Follow
// the naming rules specified in CreateDBInstance.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
// this argument is omitted, the default parameter group for the specified engine
// is used.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A list of DB security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Default: The default DB security group for the database engine.
DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB instance.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for this instance.
//
// Valid Values: mysql
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use. Choose the latest minor
// version of your database engine as specified in CreateDBInstance.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to allocate
// initially for the DB instance. For information about valid Iops values, see
// see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to Improve Performance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS).
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB instance.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB instance with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB instance, then you can
// use the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
//
// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The license model for this DB instance. Use general-public-license.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master user. The password can include any printable
// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The name for the master user.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
//
// Default: 0
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, see Setting Up and Enabling
// Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.OS.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.Enabling).
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. If MultiAZ is
// set to true, you can't set the AvailabilityZone parameter.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to associate with this DB instance. If this
// argument is omitted, the default option group for the specified engine is
// used.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), the KMS key identifier, or
// the KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Default: 3306
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The time range each day during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled. For more information, see The Backup Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.html#USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.BackupWindow).
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The time range each week during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC). For more information, see Amazon RDS Maintenance
// Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#Concepts.DBMaintenance).
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi.
//
// * Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred backup window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is publicly accessible or not. For more
// information, see CreateDBInstance.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of your Amazon S3 bucket that contains your database backup file.
//
// S3BucketName is a required field
S3BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// An AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role to allow Amazon RDS to access
// your Amazon S3 bucket.
//
// S3IngestionRoleArn is a required field
S3IngestionRoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The prefix of your Amazon S3 bucket.
S3Prefix *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the engine of your source database.
//
// Valid Values: mysql
//
// SourceEngine is a required field
SourceEngine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The engine version of your source database.
//
// Valid Values: 5.6
//
// SourceEngineVersion is a required field
SourceEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies whether the new DB instance is encrypted or not.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified; otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags to associate with this DB instance. For more information,
// see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input"}
if s.DBInstanceClass == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceClass"))
}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.S3BucketName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3BucketName"))
}
if s.S3IngestionRoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3IngestionRoleArn"))
}
if s.SourceEngine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngine"))
}
if s.SourceEngineVersion == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngineVersion"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetIops(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetLicenseModel(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMasterUsername(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetS3BucketName sets the S3BucketName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3BucketName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.S3BucketName = &v
return s
}
// SetS3IngestionRoleArn sets the S3IngestionRoleArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.S3IngestionRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetS3Prefix sets the S3Prefix field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3Prefix(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.S3Prefix = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngine sets the SourceEngine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetSourceEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngine = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngineVersion sets the SourceEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetStorageType(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
//
// Example: us-east-1a
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the DB
// instance, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the Amazon RDS DB instance, for example,
// db.m4.large. Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions,
// or for all database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and
// availability for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: The same DBInstanceClass as the original DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The database name for the restored DB instance.
//
// This parameter is not used for the MySQL or MariaDB engines.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The DB subnet group name to use for the new instance.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the Active Directory Domain to restore the instance in.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
// Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// * Aurora 5.6 or higher.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to use for the new instance.
//
// Default: The same as source
//
// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source
//
// Valid Values:
//
// * aurora
//
// * aurora-postgresql
//
// * mariadb
//
// * mysql
//
// * oracle-ee
//
// * oracle-se2
//
// * oracle-se1
//
// * oracle-se
//
// * postgres
//
// * sqlserver-ee
//
// * sqlserver-se
//
// * sqlserver-ex
//
// * sqlserver-web
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
// initially allocated for the DB instance.
//
// Constraints: Must be an integer greater than 1000.
//
// SQL Server
//
// Setting the IOPS value for the SQL Server database engine is not supported.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// License model information for the restored DB instance.
//
// Default: Same as source.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to be used for the restored DB instance.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB instance.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
//
// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
//
// * Default VPC:true
//
// * VPC:false
//
// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The date and time to restore from.
//
// Valid Values: Value must be a time in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) format
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be before the latest restorable time for the DB instance
//
// * Cannot be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is true
//
// Example: 2009-09-07T23:45:00Z
RestoreTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
// The identifier of the source DB instance from which to restore.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DB instance.
//
// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The name of the new DB instance to be created.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// TargetDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether (true) or not (false) the DB instance is restored from
// the latest backup time.
//
// Default: false
//
// Constraints: Cannot be specified if RestoreTime parameter is provided.
UseLatestRestorableTime *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput"}
if s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDomain(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetIops(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreTime sets the RestoreTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreTime(v time.Time) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.RestoreTime = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the SourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetStorageType(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the TargetDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.TargetDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetUseLatestRestorableTime sets the UseLatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetUseLatestRestorableTime(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.UseLatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The IP range to revoke access from. Must be a valid CIDR range. If CIDRIP
// is specified, EC2SecurityGroupName, EC2SecurityGroupId and EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
// can't be provided.
CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB security group to revoke ingress from.
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The id of the EC2 security group to revoke access from. For VPC DB security
// groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
// and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the EC2 security group to revoke access from. For VPC DB security
// groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
// and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS Account Number of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in
// the EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable
// value. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise,
// EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId
// must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.CIDRIP = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v
return s
}
type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup(v *DBSecurityGroup) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroup = v
return s
}
// Contains an AWS Region name as the result of a successful call to the DescribeSourceRegions
// action.
type SourceRegion struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The endpoint for the source AWS Region endpoint.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the source AWS Region.
RegionName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the source AWS Region.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s SourceRegion) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s SourceRegion) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *SourceRegion) SetEndpoint(v string) *SourceRegion {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetRegionName sets the RegionName field's value.
func (s *SourceRegion) SetRegionName(v string) *SourceRegion {
s.RegionName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *SourceRegion) SetStatus(v string) *SourceRegion {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type StartDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *StartDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StartDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *StartDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type StartDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *StartDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *StartDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type StopDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier of the DB Snapshot created immediately
// before the DB instance is stopped.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *StopDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *StopDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type StopDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *StopDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *StopDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
type Subnet struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains Availability Zone information.
//
// This data type is used as an element in the following data type:
//
// * OrderableDBInstanceOption
SubnetAvailabilityZone *AvailabilityZone `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the identifier of the subnet.
SubnetIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of the subnet.
SubnetStatus *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Subnet) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Subnet) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetSubnetAvailabilityZone sets the SubnetAvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetAvailabilityZone(v *AvailabilityZone) *Subnet {
s.SubnetAvailabilityZone = v
return s
}
// SetSubnetIdentifier sets the SubnetIdentifier field's value.
func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetIdentifier(v string) *Subnet {
s.SubnetIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetStatus sets the SubnetStatus field's value.
func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetStatus(v string) *Subnet {
s.SubnetStatus = &v
return s
}
// Metadata assigned to an Amazon RDS resource consisting of a key-value pair.
type Tag struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A key is the required name of the tag. The string value can be from 1 to
// 128 Unicode characters in length and can't be prefixed with "aws:" or "rds:".
// The string can only contain only the set of Unicode letters, digits, white-space,
// '_', '.', '/', '=', '+', '-' (Java regex: "^([\\p{L}\\p{Z}\\p{N}_.:/=+\\-]*)$").
Key *string `type:"string"`
// A value is the optional value of the tag. The string value can be from 1
// to 256 Unicode characters in length and can't be prefixed with "aws:" or
// "rds:". The string can only contain only the set of Unicode letters, digits,
// white-space, '_', '.', '/', '=', '+', '-' (Java regex: "^([\\p{L}\\p{Z}\\p{N}_.:/=+\\-]*)$").
Value *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Tag) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Tag) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
func (s *Tag) SetKey(v string) *Tag {
s.Key = &v
return s
}
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
func (s *Tag) SetValue(v string) *Tag {
s.Value = &v
return s
}
// A time zone associated with a DBInstance or a DBSnapshot. This data type
// is an element in the response to the DescribeDBInstances, the DescribeDBSnapshots,
// and the DescribeDBEngineVersions actions.
type Timezone struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the time zone.
TimezoneName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Timezone) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Timezone) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetTimezoneName sets the TimezoneName field's value.
func (s *Timezone) SetTimezoneName(v string) *Timezone {
s.TimezoneName = &v
return s
}
// The version of the database engine that a DB instance can be upgraded to.
type UpgradeTarget struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A value that indicates whether the target version is applied to any source
// DB instances that have AutoMinorVersionUpgrade set to true.
AutoUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version of the database engine that a DB instance can be upgraded to.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the upgrade target database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The version number of the upgrade target database engine.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates whether a database engine is upgraded to a major version.
IsMajorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s UpgradeTarget) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s UpgradeTarget) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAutoUpgrade sets the AutoUpgrade field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetAutoUpgrade(v bool) *UpgradeTarget {
s.AutoUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetDescription(v string) *UpgradeTarget {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetEngine(v string) *UpgradeTarget {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetEngineVersion(v string) *UpgradeTarget {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade sets the IsMajorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *UpgradeTarget {
s.IsMajorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// action. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.
type ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Valid storage options for your DB instance.
Storage []*ValidStorageOptions `locationNameList:"ValidStorageOptions" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetStorage sets the Storage field's value.
func (s *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) SetStorage(v []*ValidStorageOptions) *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage {
s.Storage = v
return s
}
// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// action.
type ValidStorageOptions struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The valid range of Provisioned IOPS to gibibytes of storage multiplier. For
// example, 3-10, which means that provisioned IOPS can be between 3 and 10
// times storage.
IopsToStorageRatio []*DoubleRange `locationNameList:"DoubleRange" type:"list"`
// The valid range of provisioned IOPS. For example, 1000-20000.
ProvisionedIops []*Range `locationNameList:"Range" type:"list"`
// The valid range of storage in gibibytes. For example, 100 to 16384.
StorageSize []*Range `locationNameList:"Range" type:"list"`
// The valid storage types for your DB instance. For example, gp2, io1.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ValidStorageOptions) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ValidStorageOptions) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetIopsToStorageRatio sets the IopsToStorageRatio field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetIopsToStorageRatio(v []*DoubleRange) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.IopsToStorageRatio = v
return s
}
// SetProvisionedIops sets the ProvisionedIops field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetProvisionedIops(v []*Range) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.ProvisionedIops = v
return s
}
// SetStorageSize sets the StorageSize field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageSize(v []*Range) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.StorageSize = v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageType(v string) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element for queries on VPC security
// group membership.
type VpcSecurityGroupMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The status of the VPC security group.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the VPC security group.
VpcSecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupId sets the VpcSecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetVpcSecurityGroupId(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership {
s.VpcSecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
const (
// ApplyMethodImmediate is a ApplyMethod enum value
ApplyMethodImmediate = "immediate"
// ApplyMethodPendingReboot is a ApplyMethod enum value
ApplyMethodPendingReboot = "pending-reboot"
)
const (
// SourceTypeDbInstance is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbInstance = "db-instance"
// SourceTypeDbParameterGroup is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbParameterGroup = "db-parameter-group"
// SourceTypeDbSecurityGroup is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbSecurityGroup = "db-security-group"
// SourceTypeDbSnapshot is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbSnapshot = "db-snapshot"
// SourceTypeDbCluster is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbCluster = "db-cluster"
// SourceTypeDbClusterSnapshot is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbClusterSnapshot = "db-cluster-snapshot"
)